1 /* Reload pseudo regs into hard regs for insns that require hard regs.
2 Copyright (C) 1987, 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998,
3 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 This file is part of GCC.
7
8 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
9 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
10 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
11 version.
12
13 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
14 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
15 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
16 for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
20 Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
21 02110-1301, USA. */
22
23 #include "config.h"
24 #include "system.h"
25 #include "coretypes.h"
26 #include "tm.h"
27
28 #include "machmode.h"
29 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
30 #include "rtl.h"
31 #include "tm_p.h"
32 #include "obstack.h"
33 #include "insn-config.h"
34 #include "flags.h"
35 #include "function.h"
36 #include "expr.h"
37 #include "optabs.h"
38 #include "regs.h"
39 #include "addresses.h"
40 #include "basic-block.h"
41 #include "reload.h"
42 #include "recog.h"
43 #include "output.h"
44 #include "real.h"
45 #include "toplev.h"
46 #include "except.h"
47 #include "tree.h"
48 #include "target.h"
49
50 /* This file contains the reload pass of the compiler, which is
51 run after register allocation has been done. It checks that
52 each insn is valid (operands required to be in registers really
53 are in registers of the proper class) and fixes up invalid ones
54 by copying values temporarily into registers for the insns
55 that need them.
56
57 The results of register allocation are described by the vector
58 reg_renumber; the insns still contain pseudo regs, but reg_renumber
59 can be used to find which hard reg, if any, a pseudo reg is in.
60
61 The technique we always use is to free up a few hard regs that are
62 called ``reload regs'', and for each place where a pseudo reg
63 must be in a hard reg, copy it temporarily into one of the reload regs.
64
65 Reload regs are allocated locally for every instruction that needs
66 reloads. When there are pseudos which are allocated to a register that
67 has been chosen as a reload reg, such pseudos must be ``spilled''.
68 This means that they go to other hard regs, or to stack slots if no other
69 available hard regs can be found. Spilling can invalidate more
70 insns, requiring additional need for reloads, so we must keep checking
71 until the process stabilizes.
72
73 For machines with different classes of registers, we must keep track
74 of the register class needed for each reload, and make sure that
75 we allocate enough reload registers of each class.
76
77 The file reload.c contains the code that checks one insn for
78 validity and reports the reloads that it needs. This file
79 is in charge of scanning the entire rtl code, accumulating the
80 reload needs, spilling, assigning reload registers to use for
81 fixing up each insn, and generating the new insns to copy values
82 into the reload registers. */
83
84 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains a REG rtx for the hard reg
85 into which reg N has been reloaded (perhaps for a previous insn). */
86 static rtx *reg_last_reload_reg;
87
88 /* Elt N nonzero if reg_last_reload_reg[N] has been set in this insn
89 for an output reload that stores into reg N. */
90 static regset_head reg_has_output_reload;
91
92 /* Indicates which hard regs are reload-registers for an output reload
93 in the current insn. */
94 static HARD_REG_SET reg_is_output_reload;
95
96 /* Element N is the constant value to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
97 or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a constant.
98 find_reloads looks at this in order to replace pseudo reg N
99 with the constant it stands for. */
100 rtx *reg_equiv_constant;
101
102 /* Element N is an invariant value to which pseudo reg N is equivalent.
103 eliminate_regs_in_insn uses this to replace pseudos in particular
104 contexts. */
105 rtx *reg_equiv_invariant;
106
107 /* Element N is a memory location to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
108 prior to any register elimination (such as frame pointer to stack
109 pointer). Depending on whether or not it is a valid address, this value
110 is transferred to either reg_equiv_address or reg_equiv_mem. */
111 rtx *reg_equiv_memory_loc;
112
113 /* We allocate reg_equiv_memory_loc inside a varray so that the garbage
114 collector can keep track of what is inside. */
115 VEC(rtx,gc) *reg_equiv_memory_loc_vec;
116
117 /* Element N is the address of stack slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent.
118 This is used when the address is not valid as a memory address
119 (because its displacement is too big for the machine.) */
120 rtx *reg_equiv_address;
121
122 /* Element N is the memory slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
123 or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a memory slot. */
124 rtx *reg_equiv_mem;
125
126 /* Element N is an EXPR_LIST of REG_EQUIVs containing MEMs with
127 alternate representations of the location of pseudo reg N. */
128 rtx *reg_equiv_alt_mem_list;
129
130 /* Widest width in which each pseudo reg is referred to (via subreg). */
131 static unsigned int *reg_max_ref_width;
132
133 /* Element N is the list of insns that initialized reg N from its equivalent
134 constant or memory slot. */
135 rtx *reg_equiv_init;
136 int reg_equiv_init_size;
137
138 /* Vector to remember old contents of reg_renumber before spilling. */
139 static short *reg_old_renumber;
140
141 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the last pseudo regno reloaded
142 into hard register N. If that pseudo reg occupied more than one register,
143 reg_reloaded_contents points to that pseudo for each spill register in
144 use; all of these must remain set for an inheritance to occur. */
145 static int reg_reloaded_contents[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
146
147 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the insn for which
148 hard register N was last used. Its contents are significant only
149 when reg_reloaded_valid is set for this register. */
150 static rtx reg_reloaded_insn[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
151
152 /* Indicate if reg_reloaded_insn / reg_reloaded_contents is valid. */
153 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_valid;
154 /* Indicate if the register was dead at the end of the reload.
155 This is only valid if reg_reloaded_contents is set and valid. */
156 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_dead;
157
158 /* Indicate whether the register's current value is one that is not
159 safe to retain across a call, even for registers that are normally
160 call-saved. */
161 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered;
162
163 /* Number of spill-regs so far; number of valid elements of spill_regs. */
164 static int n_spills;
165
166 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains REG rtx's for those regs.
167 Holds the last rtx used for any given reg, or 0 if it has never
168 been used for spilling yet. This rtx is reused, provided it has
169 the proper mode. */
170 static rtx spill_reg_rtx[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
171
172 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains nonzero for a spill reg
173 that was stored after the last time it was used.
174 The precise value is the insn generated to do the store. */
175 static rtx spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
176
177 /* This is the register that was stored with spill_reg_store. This is a
178 copy of reload_out / reload_out_reg when the value was stored; if
179 reload_out is a MEM, spill_reg_stored_to will be set to reload_out_reg. */
180 static rtx spill_reg_stored_to[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
181
182 /* This table is the inverse mapping of spill_regs:
183 indexed by hard reg number,
184 it contains the position of that reg in spill_regs,
185 or -1 for something that is not in spill_regs.
186
187 ?!? This is no longer accurate. */
188 static short spill_reg_order[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
189
190 /* This reg set indicates registers that can't be used as spill registers for
191 the currently processed insn. These are the hard registers which are live
192 during the insn, but not allocated to pseudos, as well as fixed
193 registers. */
194 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs;
195
196 /* These are the hard registers that can't be used as spill register for any
197 insn. This includes registers used for user variables and registers that
198 we can't eliminate. A register that appears in this set also can't be used
199 to retry register allocation. */
200 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs_global;
201
202 /* Describes order of use of registers for reloading
203 of spilled pseudo-registers. `n_spills' is the number of
204 elements that are actually valid; new ones are added at the end.
205
206 Both spill_regs and spill_reg_order are used on two occasions:
207 once during find_reload_regs, where they keep track of the spill registers
208 for a single insn, but also during reload_as_needed where they show all
209 the registers ever used by reload. For the latter case, the information
210 is calculated during finish_spills. */
211 static short spill_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
212
213 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard registers
214 may not be used for retrying global allocation because the register was
215 formerly spilled from one of them. If we allowed reallocating a pseudo to
216 a register that it was already allocated to, reload might not
217 terminate. */
218 static HARD_REG_SET *pseudo_previous_regs;
219
220 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard
221 registers may not be used for retrying global allocation because they
222 are used as spill registers during one of the insns in which the
223 pseudo is live. */
224 static HARD_REG_SET *pseudo_forbidden_regs;
225
226 /* All hard regs that have been used as spill registers for any insn are
227 marked in this set. */
228 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs;
229
230 /* Index of last register assigned as a spill register. We allocate in
231 a round-robin fashion. */
232 static int last_spill_reg;
233
234 /* Nonzero if indirect addressing is supported on the machine; this means
235 that spilling (REG n) does not require reloading it into a register in
236 order to do (MEM (REG n)) or (MEM (PLUS (REG n) (CONST_INT c))). The
237 value indicates the level of indirect addressing supported, e.g., two
238 means that (MEM (MEM (REG n))) is also valid if (REG n) does not get
239 a hard register. */
240 static char spill_indirect_levels;
241
242 /* Nonzero if indirect addressing is supported when the innermost MEM is
243 of the form (MEM (SYMBOL_REF sym)). It is assumed that the level to
244 which these are valid is the same as spill_indirect_levels, above. */
245 char indirect_symref_ok;
246
247 /* Nonzero if an address (plus (reg frame_pointer) (reg ...)) is valid. */
248 char double_reg_address_ok;
249
250 /* Record the stack slot for each spilled hard register. */
251 static rtx spill_stack_slot[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
252
253 /* Width allocated so far for that stack slot. */
254 static unsigned int spill_stack_slot_width[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
255
256 /* Record which pseudos needed to be spilled. */
257 static regset_head spilled_pseudos;
258
259 /* Used for communication between order_regs_for_reload and count_pseudo.
260 Used to avoid counting one pseudo twice. */
261 static regset_head pseudos_counted;
262
263 /* First uid used by insns created by reload in this function.
264 Used in find_equiv_reg. */
265 int reload_first_uid;
266
267 /* Flag set by local-alloc or global-alloc if anything is live in
268 a call-clobbered reg across calls. */
269 int caller_save_needed;
270
271 /* Set to 1 while reload_as_needed is operating.
272 Required by some machines to handle any generated moves differently. */
273 int reload_in_progress = 0;
274
275 /* These arrays record the insn_code of insns that may be needed to
276 perform input and output reloads of special objects. They provide a
277 place to pass a scratch register. */
278 enum insn_code reload_in_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
279 enum insn_code reload_out_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
280
281 /* This obstack is used for allocation of rtl during register elimination.
282 The allocated storage can be freed once find_reloads has processed the
283 insn. */
284 static struct obstack reload_obstack;
285
286 /* Points to the beginning of the reload_obstack. All insn_chain structures
287 are allocated first. */
288 static char *reload_startobj;
289
290 /* The point after all insn_chain structures. Used to quickly deallocate
291 memory allocated in copy_reloads during calculate_needs_all_insns. */
292 static char *reload_firstobj;
293
294 /* This points before all local rtl generated by register elimination.
295 Used to quickly free all memory after processing one insn. */
296 static char *reload_insn_firstobj;
297
298 /* List of insn_chain instructions, one for every insn that reload needs to
299 examine. */
300 struct insn_chain *reload_insn_chain;
301
302 /* List of all insns needing reloads. */
303 static struct insn_chain *insns_need_reload;
304
305 /* This structure is used to record information about register eliminations.
306 Each array entry describes one possible way of eliminating a register
307 in favor of another. If there is more than one way of eliminating a
308 particular register, the most preferred should be specified first. */
309
310 struct elim_table
311 {
312 int from; /* Register number to be eliminated. */
313 int to; /* Register number used as replacement. */
314 HOST_WIDE_INT initial_offset; /* Initial difference between values. */
315 int can_eliminate; /* Nonzero if this elimination can be done. */
316 int can_eliminate_previous; /* Value of CAN_ELIMINATE in previous scan over
317 insns made by reload. */
318 HOST_WIDE_INT offset; /* Current offset between the two regs. */
319 HOST_WIDE_INT previous_offset;/* Offset at end of previous insn. */
320 int ref_outside_mem; /* "to" has been referenced outside a MEM. */
321 rtx from_rtx; /* REG rtx for the register to be eliminated.
322 We cannot simply compare the number since
323 we might then spuriously replace a hard
324 register corresponding to a pseudo
325 assigned to the reg to be eliminated. */
326 rtx to_rtx; /* REG rtx for the replacement. */
327 };
328
329 static struct elim_table *reg_eliminate = 0;
330
331 /* This is an intermediate structure to initialize the table. It has
332 exactly the members provided by ELIMINABLE_REGS. */
333 static const struct elim_table_1
334 {
335 const int from;
336 const int to;
337 } reg_eliminate_1[] =
338
339 /* If a set of eliminable registers was specified, define the table from it.
340 Otherwise, default to the normal case of the frame pointer being
341 replaced by the stack pointer. */
342
343 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
344 ELIMINABLE_REGS;
345 #else
346 {{ FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}};
347 #endif
348
349 #define NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS ARRAY_SIZE (reg_eliminate_1)
350
351 /* Record the number of pending eliminations that have an offset not equal
352 to their initial offset. If nonzero, we use a new copy of each
353 replacement result in any insns encountered. */
354 int num_not_at_initial_offset;
355
356 /* Count the number of registers that we may be able to eliminate. */
357 static int num_eliminable;
358 /* And the number of registers that are equivalent to a constant that
359 can be eliminated to frame_pointer / arg_pointer + constant. */
360 static int num_eliminable_invariants;
361
362 /* For each label, we record the offset of each elimination. If we reach
363 a label by more than one path and an offset differs, we cannot do the
364 elimination. This information is indexed by the difference of the
365 number of the label and the first label number. We can't offset the
366 pointer itself as this can cause problems on machines with segmented
367 memory. The first table is an array of flags that records whether we
368 have yet encountered a label and the second table is an array of arrays,
369 one entry in the latter array for each elimination. */
370
371 static int first_label_num;
372 static char *offsets_known_at;
373 static HOST_WIDE_INT (*offsets_at)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
374
375 /* Number of labels in the current function. */
376
377 static int num_labels;
378
379 static void replace_pseudos_in (rtx *, enum machine_mode, rtx);
380 static void maybe_fix_stack_asms (void);
381 static void copy_reloads (struct insn_chain *);
382 static void calculate_needs_all_insns (int);
383 static int find_reg (struct insn_chain *, int);
384 static void find_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *);
385 static void select_reload_regs (void);
386 static void delete_caller_save_insns (void);
387
388 static void spill_failure (rtx, enum reg_class);
389 static void count_spilled_pseudo (int, int, int);
390 static void delete_dead_insn (rtx);
391 static void alter_reg (int, int);
392 static void set_label_offsets (rtx, rtx, int);
393 static void check_eliminable_occurrences (rtx);
394 static void elimination_effects (rtx, enum machine_mode);
395 static int eliminate_regs_in_insn (rtx, int);
396 static void update_eliminable_offsets (void);
397 static void mark_not_eliminable (rtx, rtx, void *);
398 static void set_initial_elim_offsets (void);
399 static bool verify_initial_elim_offsets (void);
400 static void set_initial_label_offsets (void);
401 static void set_offsets_for_label (rtx);
402 static void init_elim_table (void);
403 static void update_eliminables (HARD_REG_SET *);
404 static void spill_hard_reg (unsigned int, int);
405 static int finish_spills (int);
406 static void scan_paradoxical_subregs (rtx);
407 static void count_pseudo (int);
408 static void order_regs_for_reload (struct insn_chain *);
409 static void reload_as_needed (int);
410 static void forget_old_reloads_1 (rtx, rtx, void *);
411 static void forget_marked_reloads (regset);
412 static int reload_reg_class_lower (const void *, const void *);
413 static void mark_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type,
414 enum machine_mode);
415 static void clear_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type,
416 enum machine_mode);
417 static int reload_reg_free_p (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type);
418 static int reload_reg_free_for_value_p (int, int, int, enum reload_type,
419 rtx, rtx, int, int);
420 static int free_for_value_p (int, enum machine_mode, int, enum reload_type,
421 rtx, rtx, int, int);
422 static int reload_reg_reaches_end_p (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type);
423 static int allocate_reload_reg (struct insn_chain *, int, int);
424 static int conflicts_with_override (rtx);
425 static void failed_reload (rtx, int);
426 static int set_reload_reg (int, int);
427 static void choose_reload_regs_init (struct insn_chain *, rtx *);
428 static void choose_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *);
429 static void merge_assigned_reloads (rtx);
430 static void emit_input_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *,
431 rtx, int);
432 static void emit_output_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *,
433 int);
434 static void do_input_reload (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *, int);
435 static void do_output_reload (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *, int);
436 static bool inherit_piecemeal_p (int, int);
437 static void emit_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *);
438 static void delete_output_reload (rtx, int, int);
439 static void delete_address_reloads (rtx, rtx);
440 static void delete_address_reloads_1 (rtx, rtx, rtx);
441 static rtx inc_for_reload (rtx, rtx, rtx, int);
442 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
443 static void add_auto_inc_notes (rtx, rtx);
444 #endif
445 static void copy_eh_notes (rtx, rtx);
446 static int reloads_conflict (int, int);
447 static rtx gen_reload (rtx, rtx, int, enum reload_type);
448 static rtx emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (rtx);
449
450 /* Initialize the reload pass once per compilation. */
451
452 void
init_reload(void)453 init_reload (void)
454 {
455 int i;
456
457 /* Often (MEM (REG n)) is still valid even if (REG n) is put on the stack.
458 Set spill_indirect_levels to the number of levels such addressing is
459 permitted, zero if it is not permitted at all. */
460
461 rtx tem
462 = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode,
463 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
464 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode,
465 LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1),
466 GEN_INT (4)));
467 spill_indirect_levels = 0;
468
469 while (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
470 {
471 spill_indirect_levels++;
472 tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, tem);
473 }
474
475 /* See if indirect addressing is valid for (MEM (SYMBOL_REF ...)). */
476
477 tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, "foo"));
478 indirect_symref_ok = memory_address_p (QImode, tem);
479
480 /* See if reg+reg is a valid (and offsettable) address. */
481
482 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
483 {
484 tem = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
485 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM),
486 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, i));
487
488 /* This way, we make sure that reg+reg is an offsettable address. */
489 tem = plus_constant (tem, 4);
490
491 if (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
492 {
493 double_reg_address_ok = 1;
494 break;
495 }
496 }
497
498 /* Initialize obstack for our rtl allocation. */
499 gcc_obstack_init (&reload_obstack);
500 reload_startobj = obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
501
502 INIT_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
503 INIT_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
504 }
505
506 /* List of insn chains that are currently unused. */
507 static struct insn_chain *unused_insn_chains = 0;
508
509 /* Allocate an empty insn_chain structure. */
510 struct insn_chain *
new_insn_chain(void)511 new_insn_chain (void)
512 {
513 struct insn_chain *c;
514
515 if (unused_insn_chains == 0)
516 {
517 c = obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, sizeof (struct insn_chain));
518 INIT_REG_SET (&c->live_throughout);
519 INIT_REG_SET (&c->dead_or_set);
520 }
521 else
522 {
523 c = unused_insn_chains;
524 unused_insn_chains = c->next;
525 }
526 c->is_caller_save_insn = 0;
527 c->need_operand_change = 0;
528 c->need_reload = 0;
529 c->need_elim = 0;
530 return c;
531 }
532
533 /* Small utility function to set all regs in hard reg set TO which are
534 allocated to pseudos in regset FROM. */
535
536 void
compute_use_by_pseudos(HARD_REG_SET * to,regset from)537 compute_use_by_pseudos (HARD_REG_SET *to, regset from)
538 {
539 unsigned int regno;
540 reg_set_iterator rsi;
541
542 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (from, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, regno, rsi)
543 {
544 int r = reg_renumber[regno];
545 int nregs;
546
547 if (r < 0)
548 {
549 /* reload_combine uses the information from
550 BASIC_BLOCK->global_live_at_start, which might still
551 contain registers that have not actually been allocated
552 since they have an equivalence. */
553 gcc_assert (reload_completed);
554 }
555 else
556 {
557 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[r][PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno)];
558 while (nregs-- > 0)
559 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*to, r + nregs);
560 }
561 }
562 }
563
564 /* Replace all pseudos found in LOC with their corresponding
565 equivalences. */
566
567 static void
replace_pseudos_in(rtx * loc,enum machine_mode mem_mode,rtx usage)568 replace_pseudos_in (rtx *loc, enum machine_mode mem_mode, rtx usage)
569 {
570 rtx x = *loc;
571 enum rtx_code code;
572 const char *fmt;
573 int i, j;
574
575 if (! x)
576 return;
577
578 code = GET_CODE (x);
579 if (code == REG)
580 {
581 unsigned int regno = REGNO (x);
582
583 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
584 return;
585
586 x = eliminate_regs (x, mem_mode, usage);
587 if (x != *loc)
588 {
589 *loc = x;
590 replace_pseudos_in (loc, mem_mode, usage);
591 return;
592 }
593
594 if (reg_equiv_constant[regno])
595 *loc = reg_equiv_constant[regno];
596 else if (reg_equiv_mem[regno])
597 *loc = reg_equiv_mem[regno];
598 else if (reg_equiv_address[regno])
599 *loc = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (x), reg_equiv_address[regno]);
600 else
601 {
602 gcc_assert (!REG_P (regno_reg_rtx[regno])
603 || REGNO (regno_reg_rtx[regno]) != regno);
604 *loc = regno_reg_rtx[regno];
605 }
606
607 return;
608 }
609 else if (code == MEM)
610 {
611 replace_pseudos_in (& XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x), usage);
612 return;
613 }
614
615 /* Process each of our operands recursively. */
616 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
617 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
618 if (*fmt == 'e')
619 replace_pseudos_in (&XEXP (x, i), mem_mode, usage);
620 else if (*fmt == 'E')
621 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
622 replace_pseudos_in (& XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode, usage);
623 }
624
625
626 /* Global variables used by reload and its subroutines. */
627
628 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs register elimination. */
629 static int something_needs_elimination;
630 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs an operand changed. */
631 static int something_needs_operands_changed;
632
633 /* Nonzero means we couldn't get enough spill regs. */
634 static int failure;
635
636 /* Main entry point for the reload pass.
637
638 FIRST is the first insn of the function being compiled.
639
640 GLOBAL nonzero means we were called from global_alloc
641 and should attempt to reallocate any pseudoregs that we
642 displace from hard regs we will use for reloads.
643 If GLOBAL is zero, we do not have enough information to do that,
644 so any pseudo reg that is spilled must go to the stack.
645
646 Return value is nonzero if reload failed
647 and we must not do any more for this function. */
648
649 int
reload(rtx first,int global)650 reload (rtx first, int global)
651 {
652 int i;
653 rtx insn;
654 struct elim_table *ep;
655 basic_block bb;
656
657 /* Make sure even insns with volatile mem refs are recognizable. */
658 init_recog ();
659
660 failure = 0;
661
662 reload_firstobj = obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
663
664 /* Make sure that the last insn in the chain
665 is not something that needs reloading. */
666 emit_note (NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
667
668 /* Enable find_equiv_reg to distinguish insns made by reload. */
669 reload_first_uid = get_max_uid ();
670
671 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
672 /* Initialize the secondary memory table. */
673 clear_secondary_mem ();
674 #endif
675
676 /* We don't have a stack slot for any spill reg yet. */
677 memset (spill_stack_slot, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot);
678 memset (spill_stack_slot_width, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot_width);
679
680 /* Initialize the save area information for caller-save, in case some
681 are needed. */
682 init_save_areas ();
683
684 /* Compute which hard registers are now in use
685 as homes for pseudo registers.
686 This is done here rather than (eg) in global_alloc
687 because this point is reached even if not optimizing. */
688 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
689 mark_home_live (i);
690
691 /* A function that receives a nonlocal goto must save all call-saved
692 registers. */
693 if (current_function_has_nonlocal_label)
694 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
695 if (! call_used_regs[i] && ! fixed_regs[i] && ! LOCAL_REGNO (i))
696 regs_ever_live[i] = 1;
697
698 /* Find all the pseudo registers that didn't get hard regs
699 but do have known equivalent constants or memory slots.
700 These include parameters (known equivalent to parameter slots)
701 and cse'd or loop-moved constant memory addresses.
702
703 Record constant equivalents in reg_equiv_constant
704 so they will be substituted by find_reloads.
705 Record memory equivalents in reg_mem_equiv so they can
706 be substituted eventually by altering the REG-rtx's. */
707
708 reg_equiv_constant = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
709 reg_equiv_invariant = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
710 reg_equiv_mem = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
711 reg_equiv_alt_mem_list = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
712 reg_equiv_address = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
713 reg_max_ref_width = XCNEWVEC (unsigned int, max_regno);
714 reg_old_renumber = XCNEWVEC (short, max_regno);
715 memcpy (reg_old_renumber, reg_renumber, max_regno * sizeof (short));
716 pseudo_forbidden_regs = XNEWVEC (HARD_REG_SET, max_regno);
717 pseudo_previous_regs = XCNEWVEC (HARD_REG_SET, max_regno);
718
719 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs_global);
720
721 /* Look for REG_EQUIV notes; record what each pseudo is equivalent
722 to. Also find all paradoxical subregs and find largest such for
723 each pseudo. */
724
725 num_eliminable_invariants = 0;
726 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
727 {
728 rtx set = single_set (insn);
729
730 /* We may introduce USEs that we want to remove at the end, so
731 we'll mark them with QImode. Make sure there are no
732 previously-marked insns left by say regmove. */
733 if (INSN_P (insn) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
734 && GET_MODE (insn) != VOIDmode)
735 PUT_MODE (insn, VOIDmode);
736
737 if (INSN_P (insn))
738 scan_paradoxical_subregs (PATTERN (insn));
739
740 if (set != 0 && REG_P (SET_DEST (set)))
741 {
742 rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, NULL_RTX);
743 rtx x;
744
745 if (! note)
746 continue;
747
748 i = REGNO (SET_DEST (set));
749 x = XEXP (note, 0);
750
751 if (i <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
752 continue;
753
754 if (! function_invariant_p (x)
755 || ! flag_pic
756 /* A function invariant is often CONSTANT_P but may
757 include a register. We promise to only pass
758 CONSTANT_P objects to LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P. */
759 || (CONSTANT_P (x)
760 && LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (x)))
761 {
762 /* It can happen that a REG_EQUIV note contains a MEM
763 that is not a legitimate memory operand. As later
764 stages of reload assume that all addresses found
765 in the reg_equiv_* arrays were originally legitimate,
766 we ignore such REG_EQUIV notes. */
767 if (memory_operand (x, VOIDmode))
768 {
769 /* Always unshare the equivalence, so we can
770 substitute into this insn without touching the
771 equivalence. */
772 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = copy_rtx (x);
773 }
774 else if (function_invariant_p (x))
775 {
776 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
777 {
778 /* This is PLUS of frame pointer and a constant,
779 and might be shared. Unshare it. */
780 reg_equiv_invariant[i] = copy_rtx (x);
781 num_eliminable_invariants++;
782 }
783 else if (x == frame_pointer_rtx || x == arg_pointer_rtx)
784 {
785 reg_equiv_invariant[i] = x;
786 num_eliminable_invariants++;
787 }
788 else if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
789 reg_equiv_constant[i] = x;
790 else
791 {
792 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]
793 = force_const_mem (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)), x);
794 if (! reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
795 reg_equiv_init[i] = NULL_RTX;
796 }
797 }
798 else
799 {
800 reg_equiv_init[i] = NULL_RTX;
801 continue;
802 }
803 }
804 else
805 reg_equiv_init[i] = NULL_RTX;
806 }
807 }
808
809 if (dump_file)
810 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
811 if (reg_equiv_init[i])
812 {
813 fprintf (dump_file, "init_insns for %u: ", i);
814 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, reg_equiv_init[i], 20);
815 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
816 }
817
818 init_elim_table ();
819
820 first_label_num = get_first_label_num ();
821 num_labels = max_label_num () - first_label_num;
822
823 /* Allocate the tables used to store offset information at labels. */
824 /* We used to use alloca here, but the size of what it would try to
825 allocate would occasionally cause it to exceed the stack limit and
826 cause a core dump. */
827 offsets_known_at = XNEWVEC (char, num_labels);
828 offsets_at = (HOST_WIDE_INT (*)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]) xmalloc (num_labels * NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
829
830 /* Alter each pseudo-reg rtx to contain its hard reg number.
831 Assign stack slots to the pseudos that lack hard regs or equivalents.
832 Do not touch virtual registers. */
833
834 for (i = LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1; i < max_regno; i++)
835 alter_reg (i, -1);
836
837 /* If we have some registers we think can be eliminated, scan all insns to
838 see if there is an insn that sets one of these registers to something
839 other than itself plus a constant. If so, the register cannot be
840 eliminated. Doing this scan here eliminates an extra pass through the
841 main reload loop in the most common case where register elimination
842 cannot be done. */
843 for (insn = first; insn && num_eliminable; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
844 if (INSN_P (insn))
845 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), mark_not_eliminable, NULL);
846
847 maybe_fix_stack_asms ();
848
849 insns_need_reload = 0;
850 something_needs_elimination = 0;
851
852 /* Initialize to -1, which means take the first spill register. */
853 last_spill_reg = -1;
854
855 /* Spill any hard regs that we know we can't eliminate. */
856 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs);
857 /* There can be multiple ways to eliminate a register;
858 they should be listed adjacently.
859 Elimination for any register fails only if all possible ways fail. */
860 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; )
861 {
862 int from = ep->from;
863 int can_eliminate = 0;
864 do
865 {
866 can_eliminate |= ep->can_eliminate;
867 ep++;
868 }
869 while (ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS] && ep->from == from);
870 if (! can_eliminate)
871 spill_hard_reg (from, 1);
872 }
873
874 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
875 if (frame_pointer_needed)
876 spill_hard_reg (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, 1);
877 #endif
878 finish_spills (global);
879
880 /* From now on, we may need to generate moves differently. We may also
881 allow modifications of insns which cause them to not be recognized.
882 Any such modifications will be cleaned up during reload itself. */
883 reload_in_progress = 1;
884
885 /* This loop scans the entire function each go-round
886 and repeats until one repetition spills no additional hard regs. */
887 for (;;)
888 {
889 int something_changed;
890 int did_spill;
891
892 HOST_WIDE_INT starting_frame_size;
893
894 /* Round size of stack frame to stack_alignment_needed. This must be done
895 here because the stack size may be a part of the offset computation
896 for register elimination, and there might have been new stack slots
897 created in the last iteration of this loop. */
898 if (cfun->stack_alignment_needed)
899 assign_stack_local (BLKmode, 0, cfun->stack_alignment_needed);
900
901 starting_frame_size = get_frame_size ();
902
903 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
904 set_initial_label_offsets ();
905
906 /* For each pseudo register that has an equivalent location defined,
907 try to eliminate any eliminable registers (such as the frame pointer)
908 assuming initial offsets for the replacement register, which
909 is the normal case.
910
911 If the resulting location is directly addressable, substitute
912 the MEM we just got directly for the old REG.
913
914 If it is not addressable but is a constant or the sum of a hard reg
915 and constant, it is probably not addressable because the constant is
916 out of range, in that case record the address; we will generate
917 hairy code to compute the address in a register each time it is
918 needed. Similarly if it is a hard register, but one that is not
919 valid as an address register.
920
921 If the location is not addressable, but does not have one of the
922 above forms, assign a stack slot. We have to do this to avoid the
923 potential of producing lots of reloads if, e.g., a location involves
924 a pseudo that didn't get a hard register and has an equivalent memory
925 location that also involves a pseudo that didn't get a hard register.
926
927 Perhaps at some point we will improve reload_when_needed handling
928 so this problem goes away. But that's very hairy. */
929
930 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
931 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
932 {
933 rtx x = eliminate_regs (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i], 0, NULL_RTX);
934
935 if (strict_memory_address_p (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]),
936 XEXP (x, 0)))
937 reg_equiv_mem[i] = x, reg_equiv_address[i] = 0;
938 else if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0))
939 || (REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
940 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
941 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
942 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
943 && (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
944 < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
945 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))))
946 reg_equiv_address[i] = XEXP (x, 0), reg_equiv_mem[i] = 0;
947 else
948 {
949 /* Make a new stack slot. Then indicate that something
950 changed so we go back and recompute offsets for
951 eliminable registers because the allocation of memory
952 below might change some offset. reg_equiv_{mem,address}
953 will be set up for this pseudo on the next pass around
954 the loop. */
955 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = 0;
956 reg_equiv_init[i] = 0;
957 alter_reg (i, -1);
958 }
959 }
960
961 if (caller_save_needed)
962 setup_save_areas ();
963
964 /* If we allocated another stack slot, redo elimination bookkeeping. */
965 if (starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
966 continue;
967
968 if (caller_save_needed)
969 {
970 save_call_clobbered_regs ();
971 /* That might have allocated new insn_chain structures. */
972 reload_firstobj = obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
973 }
974
975 calculate_needs_all_insns (global);
976
977 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
978 did_spill = 0;
979
980 something_changed = 0;
981
982 /* If we allocated any new memory locations, make another pass
983 since it might have changed elimination offsets. */
984 if (starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
985 something_changed = 1;
986
987 /* Even if the frame size remained the same, we might still have
988 changed elimination offsets, e.g. if find_reloads called
989 force_const_mem requiring the back end to allocate a constant
990 pool base register that needs to be saved on the stack. */
991 else if (!verify_initial_elim_offsets ())
992 something_changed = 1;
993
994 {
995 HARD_REG_SET to_spill;
996 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (to_spill);
997 update_eliminables (&to_spill);
998 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET(used_spill_regs, to_spill);
999
1000 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1001 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (to_spill, i))
1002 {
1003 spill_hard_reg (i, 1);
1004 did_spill = 1;
1005
1006 /* Regardless of the state of spills, if we previously had
1007 a register that we thought we could eliminate, but now can
1008 not eliminate, we must run another pass.
1009
1010 Consider pseudos which have an entry in reg_equiv_* which
1011 reference an eliminable register. We must make another pass
1012 to update reg_equiv_* so that we do not substitute in the
1013 old value from when we thought the elimination could be
1014 performed. */
1015 something_changed = 1;
1016 }
1017 }
1018
1019 select_reload_regs ();
1020 if (failure)
1021 goto failed;
1022
1023 if (insns_need_reload != 0 || did_spill)
1024 something_changed |= finish_spills (global);
1025
1026 if (! something_changed)
1027 break;
1028
1029 if (caller_save_needed)
1030 delete_caller_save_insns ();
1031
1032 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_firstobj);
1033 }
1034
1035 /* If global-alloc was run, notify it of any register eliminations we have
1036 done. */
1037 if (global)
1038 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
1039 if (ep->can_eliminate)
1040 mark_elimination (ep->from, ep->to);
1041
1042 /* If a pseudo has no hard reg, delete the insns that made the equivalence.
1043 If that insn didn't set the register (i.e., it copied the register to
1044 memory), just delete that insn instead of the equivalencing insn plus
1045 anything now dead. If we call delete_dead_insn on that insn, we may
1046 delete the insn that actually sets the register if the register dies
1047 there and that is incorrect. */
1048
1049 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
1050 {
1051 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_init[i] != 0)
1052 {
1053 rtx list;
1054 for (list = reg_equiv_init[i]; list; list = XEXP (list, 1))
1055 {
1056 rtx equiv_insn = XEXP (list, 0);
1057
1058 /* If we already deleted the insn or if it may trap, we can't
1059 delete it. The latter case shouldn't happen, but can
1060 if an insn has a variable address, gets a REG_EH_REGION
1061 note added to it, and then gets converted into a load
1062 from a constant address. */
1063 if (NOTE_P (equiv_insn)
1064 || can_throw_internal (equiv_insn))
1065 ;
1066 else if (reg_set_p (regno_reg_rtx[i], PATTERN (equiv_insn)))
1067 delete_dead_insn (equiv_insn);
1068 else
1069 SET_INSN_DELETED (equiv_insn);
1070 }
1071 }
1072 }
1073
1074 /* Use the reload registers where necessary
1075 by generating move instructions to move the must-be-register
1076 values into or out of the reload registers. */
1077
1078 if (insns_need_reload != 0 || something_needs_elimination
1079 || something_needs_operands_changed)
1080 {
1081 HOST_WIDE_INT old_frame_size = get_frame_size ();
1082
1083 reload_as_needed (global);
1084
1085 gcc_assert (old_frame_size == get_frame_size ());
1086
1087 gcc_assert (verify_initial_elim_offsets ());
1088 }
1089
1090 /* If we were able to eliminate the frame pointer, show that it is no
1091 longer live at the start of any basic block. If it ls live by
1092 virtue of being in a pseudo, that pseudo will be marked live
1093 and hence the frame pointer will be known to be live via that
1094 pseudo. */
1095
1096 if (! frame_pointer_needed)
1097 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
1098 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (bb->il.rtl->global_live_at_start,
1099 HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1100
1101 /* Come here (with failure set nonzero) if we can't get enough spill
1102 regs. */
1103 failed:
1104
1105 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
1106 reload_in_progress = 0;
1107
1108 /* Now eliminate all pseudo regs by modifying them into
1109 their equivalent memory references.
1110 The REG-rtx's for the pseudos are modified in place,
1111 so all insns that used to refer to them now refer to memory.
1112
1113 For a reg that has a reg_equiv_address, all those insns
1114 were changed by reloading so that no insns refer to it any longer;
1115 but the DECL_RTL of a variable decl may refer to it,
1116 and if so this causes the debugging info to mention the variable. */
1117
1118 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
1119 {
1120 rtx addr = 0;
1121
1122 if (reg_equiv_mem[i])
1123 addr = XEXP (reg_equiv_mem[i], 0);
1124
1125 if (reg_equiv_address[i])
1126 addr = reg_equiv_address[i];
1127
1128 if (addr)
1129 {
1130 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0)
1131 {
1132 rtx reg = regno_reg_rtx[i];
1133
1134 REG_USERVAR_P (reg) = 0;
1135 PUT_CODE (reg, MEM);
1136 XEXP (reg, 0) = addr;
1137 if (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
1138 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (reg, reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]);
1139 else
1140 {
1141 MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (reg) = MEM_SCALAR_P (reg) = 0;
1142 MEM_ATTRS (reg) = 0;
1143 }
1144 MEM_NOTRAP_P (reg) = 1;
1145 }
1146 else if (reg_equiv_mem[i])
1147 XEXP (reg_equiv_mem[i], 0) = addr;
1148 }
1149 }
1150
1151 /* We must set reload_completed now since the cleanup_subreg_operands call
1152 below will re-recognize each insn and reload may have generated insns
1153 which are only valid during and after reload. */
1154 reload_completed = 1;
1155
1156 /* Make a pass over all the insns and delete all USEs which we inserted
1157 only to tag a REG_EQUAL note on them. Remove all REG_DEAD and REG_UNUSED
1158 notes. Delete all CLOBBER insns, except those that refer to the return
1159 value and the special mem:BLK CLOBBERs added to prevent the scheduler
1160 from misarranging variable-array code, and simplify (subreg (reg))
1161 operands. Also remove all REG_RETVAL and REG_LIBCALL notes since they
1162 are no longer useful or accurate. Strip and regenerate REG_INC notes
1163 that may have been moved around. */
1164
1165 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1166 if (INSN_P (insn))
1167 {
1168 rtx *pnote;
1169
1170 if (CALL_P (insn))
1171 replace_pseudos_in (& CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn),
1172 VOIDmode, CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn));
1173
1174 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
1175 /* We mark with QImode USEs introduced by reload itself. */
1176 && (GET_MODE (insn) == QImode
1177 || find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX)))
1178 || (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
1179 && (!MEM_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0))
1180 || GET_MODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)) != BLKmode
1181 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)) != SCRATCH
1182 && XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)
1183 != stack_pointer_rtx))
1184 && (!REG_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0))
1185 || ! REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)))))
1186 {
1187 delete_insn (insn);
1188 continue;
1189 }
1190
1191 /* Some CLOBBERs may survive until here and still reference unassigned
1192 pseudos with const equivalent, which may in turn cause ICE in later
1193 passes if the reference remains in place. */
1194 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER)
1195 replace_pseudos_in (& XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0),
1196 VOIDmode, PATTERN (insn));
1197
1198 /* Discard obvious no-ops, even without -O. This optimization
1199 is fast and doesn't interfere with debugging. */
1200 if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn)
1201 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET
1202 && REG_P (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)))
1203 && REG_P (SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn)))
1204 && (REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)))
1205 == REGNO (SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn)))))
1206 {
1207 delete_insn (insn);
1208 continue;
1209 }
1210
1211 pnote = ®_NOTES (insn);
1212 while (*pnote != 0)
1213 {
1214 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_DEAD
1215 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_UNUSED
1216 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_INC
1217 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_RETVAL
1218 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_LIBCALL)
1219 *pnote = XEXP (*pnote, 1);
1220 else
1221 pnote = &XEXP (*pnote, 1);
1222 }
1223
1224 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
1225 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, PATTERN (insn));
1226 #endif
1227
1228 /* Simplify (subreg (reg)) if it appears as an operand. */
1229 cleanup_subreg_operands (insn);
1230
1231 /* Clean up invalid ASMs so that they don't confuse later passes.
1232 See PR 21299. */
1233 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
1234 {
1235 extract_insn (insn);
1236 if (!constrain_operands (1))
1237 {
1238 error_for_asm (insn,
1239 "%<asm%> operand has impossible constraints");
1240 delete_insn (insn);
1241 continue;
1242 }
1243 }
1244 }
1245
1246 /* If we are doing stack checking, give a warning if this function's
1247 frame size is larger than we expect. */
1248 if (flag_stack_check && ! STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN)
1249 {
1250 HOST_WIDE_INT size = get_frame_size () + STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE;
1251 static int verbose_warned = 0;
1252
1253 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1254 if (regs_ever_live[i] && ! fixed_regs[i] && call_used_regs[i])
1255 size += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1256
1257 if (size > STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE)
1258 {
1259 warning (0, "frame size too large for reliable stack checking");
1260 if (! verbose_warned)
1261 {
1262 warning (0, "try reducing the number of local variables");
1263 verbose_warned = 1;
1264 }
1265 }
1266 }
1267
1268 /* Indicate that we no longer have known memory locations or constants. */
1269 if (reg_equiv_constant)
1270 free (reg_equiv_constant);
1271 if (reg_equiv_invariant)
1272 free (reg_equiv_invariant);
1273 reg_equiv_constant = 0;
1274 reg_equiv_invariant = 0;
1275 VEC_free (rtx, gc, reg_equiv_memory_loc_vec);
1276 reg_equiv_memory_loc = 0;
1277
1278 if (offsets_known_at)
1279 free (offsets_known_at);
1280 if (offsets_at)
1281 free (offsets_at);
1282
1283 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1284 if (reg_equiv_alt_mem_list[i])
1285 free_EXPR_LIST_list (®_equiv_alt_mem_list[i]);
1286 free (reg_equiv_alt_mem_list);
1287
1288 free (reg_equiv_mem);
1289 reg_equiv_init = 0;
1290 free (reg_equiv_address);
1291 free (reg_max_ref_width);
1292 free (reg_old_renumber);
1293 free (pseudo_previous_regs);
1294 free (pseudo_forbidden_regs);
1295
1296 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs);
1297 for (i = 0; i < n_spills; i++)
1298 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs, spill_regs[i]);
1299
1300 /* Free all the insn_chain structures at once. */
1301 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_startobj);
1302 unused_insn_chains = 0;
1303 fixup_abnormal_edges ();
1304
1305 /* Replacing pseudos with their memory equivalents might have
1306 created shared rtx. Subsequent passes would get confused
1307 by this, so unshare everything here. */
1308 unshare_all_rtl_again (first);
1309
1310 #ifdef STACK_BOUNDARY
1311 /* init_emit has set the alignment of the hard frame pointer
1312 to STACK_BOUNDARY. It is very likely no longer valid if
1313 the hard frame pointer was used for register allocation. */
1314 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
1315 REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM) = BITS_PER_UNIT;
1316 #endif
1317
1318 return failure;
1319 }
1320
1321 /* Yet another special case. Unfortunately, reg-stack forces people to
1322 write incorrect clobbers in asm statements. These clobbers must not
1323 cause the register to appear in bad_spill_regs, otherwise we'll call
1324 fatal_insn later. We clear the corresponding regnos in the live
1325 register sets to avoid this.
1326 The whole thing is rather sick, I'm afraid. */
1327
1328 static void
maybe_fix_stack_asms(void)1329 maybe_fix_stack_asms (void)
1330 {
1331 #ifdef STACK_REGS
1332 const char *constraints[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
1333 enum machine_mode operand_mode[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
1334 struct insn_chain *chain;
1335
1336 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain != 0; chain = chain->next)
1337 {
1338 int i, noperands;
1339 HARD_REG_SET clobbered, allowed;
1340 rtx pat;
1341
1342 if (! INSN_P (chain->insn)
1343 || (noperands = asm_noperands (PATTERN (chain->insn))) < 0)
1344 continue;
1345 pat = PATTERN (chain->insn);
1346 if (GET_CODE (pat) != PARALLEL)
1347 continue;
1348
1349 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (clobbered);
1350 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed);
1351
1352 /* First, make a mask of all stack regs that are clobbered. */
1353 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (pat, 0); i++)
1354 {
1355 rtx t = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
1356 if (GET_CODE (t) == CLOBBER && STACK_REG_P (XEXP (t, 0)))
1357 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (clobbered, REGNO (XEXP (t, 0)));
1358 }
1359
1360 /* Get the operand values and constraints out of the insn. */
1361 decode_asm_operands (pat, recog_data.operand, recog_data.operand_loc,
1362 constraints, operand_mode);
1363
1364 /* For every operand, see what registers are allowed. */
1365 for (i = 0; i < noperands; i++)
1366 {
1367 const char *p = constraints[i];
1368 /* For every alternative, we compute the class of registers allowed
1369 for reloading in CLS, and merge its contents into the reg set
1370 ALLOWED. */
1371 int cls = (int) NO_REGS;
1372
1373 for (;;)
1374 {
1375 char c = *p;
1376
1377 if (c == '\0' || c == ',' || c == '#')
1378 {
1379 /* End of one alternative - mark the regs in the current
1380 class, and reset the class. */
1381 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed, reg_class_contents[cls]);
1382 cls = NO_REGS;
1383 p++;
1384 if (c == '#')
1385 do {
1386 c = *p++;
1387 } while (c != '\0' && c != ',');
1388 if (c == '\0')
1389 break;
1390 continue;
1391 }
1392
1393 switch (c)
1394 {
1395 case '=': case '+': case '*': case '%': case '?': case '!':
1396 case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': case 'm':
1397 case '<': case '>': case 'V': case 'o': case '&': case 'E':
1398 case 'F': case 's': case 'i': case 'n': case 'X': case 'I':
1399 case 'J': case 'K': case 'L': case 'M': case 'N': case 'O':
1400 case 'P':
1401 break;
1402
1403 case 'p':
1404 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls]
1405 [(int) base_reg_class (VOIDmode, ADDRESS, SCRATCH)];
1406 break;
1407
1408 case 'g':
1409 case 'r':
1410 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls][(int) GENERAL_REGS];
1411 break;
1412
1413 default:
1414 if (EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (c, p))
1415 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls]
1416 [(int) base_reg_class (VOIDmode, ADDRESS, SCRATCH)];
1417 else
1418 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls]
1419 [(int) REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (c, p)];
1420 }
1421 p += CONSTRAINT_LEN (c, p);
1422 }
1423 }
1424 /* Those of the registers which are clobbered, but allowed by the
1425 constraints, must be usable as reload registers. So clear them
1426 out of the life information. */
1427 AND_HARD_REG_SET (allowed, clobbered);
1428 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1429 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (allowed, i))
1430 {
1431 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain->live_throughout, i);
1432 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain->dead_or_set, i);
1433 }
1434 }
1435
1436 #endif
1437 }
1438
1439 /* Copy the global variables n_reloads and rld into the corresponding elts
1440 of CHAIN. */
1441 static void
copy_reloads(struct insn_chain * chain)1442 copy_reloads (struct insn_chain *chain)
1443 {
1444 chain->n_reloads = n_reloads;
1445 chain->rld = obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack,
1446 n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1447 memcpy (chain->rld, rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1448 reload_insn_firstobj = obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
1449 }
1450
1451 /* Walk the chain of insns, and determine for each whether it needs reloads
1452 and/or eliminations. Build the corresponding insns_need_reload list, and
1453 set something_needs_elimination as appropriate. */
1454 static void
calculate_needs_all_insns(int global)1455 calculate_needs_all_insns (int global)
1456 {
1457 struct insn_chain **pprev_reload = &insns_need_reload;
1458 struct insn_chain *chain, *next = 0;
1459
1460 something_needs_elimination = 0;
1461
1462 reload_insn_firstobj = obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);
1463 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain != 0; chain = next)
1464 {
1465 rtx insn = chain->insn;
1466
1467 next = chain->next;
1468
1469 /* Clear out the shortcuts. */
1470 chain->n_reloads = 0;
1471 chain->need_elim = 0;
1472 chain->need_reload = 0;
1473 chain->need_operand_change = 0;
1474
1475 /* If this is a label, a JUMP_INSN, or has REG_NOTES (which might
1476 include REG_LABEL), we need to see what effects this has on the
1477 known offsets at labels. */
1478
1479 if (LABEL_P (insn) || JUMP_P (insn)
1480 || (INSN_P (insn) && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0))
1481 set_label_offsets (insn, insn, 0);
1482
1483 if (INSN_P (insn))
1484 {
1485 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
1486 int old_code = INSN_CODE (insn);
1487 rtx old_notes = REG_NOTES (insn);
1488 int did_elimination = 0;
1489 int operands_changed = 0;
1490 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1491
1492 /* Skip insns that only set an equivalence. */
1493 if (set && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
1494 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))] < 0
1495 && (reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))]
1496 || (reg_equiv_invariant[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))]))
1497 && reg_equiv_init[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))])
1498 continue;
1499
1500 /* If needed, eliminate any eliminable registers. */
1501 if (num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants)
1502 did_elimination = eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 0);
1503
1504 /* Analyze the instruction. */
1505 operands_changed = find_reloads (insn, 0, spill_indirect_levels,
1506 global, spill_reg_order);
1507
1508 /* If a no-op set needs more than one reload, this is likely
1509 to be something that needs input address reloads. We
1510 can't get rid of this cleanly later, and it is of no use
1511 anyway, so discard it now.
1512 We only do this when expensive_optimizations is enabled,
1513 since this complements reload inheritance / output
1514 reload deletion, and it can make debugging harder. */
1515 if (flag_expensive_optimizations && n_reloads > 1)
1516 {
1517 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1518 if (set
1519 && SET_SRC (set) == SET_DEST (set)
1520 && REG_P (SET_SRC (set))
1521 && REGNO (SET_SRC (set)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1522 {
1523 delete_insn (insn);
1524 /* Delete it from the reload chain. */
1525 if (chain->prev)
1526 chain->prev->next = next;
1527 else
1528 reload_insn_chain = next;
1529 if (next)
1530 next->prev = chain->prev;
1531 chain->next = unused_insn_chains;
1532 unused_insn_chains = chain;
1533 continue;
1534 }
1535 }
1536 if (num_eliminable)
1537 update_eliminable_offsets ();
1538
1539 /* Remember for later shortcuts which insns had any reloads or
1540 register eliminations. */
1541 chain->need_elim = did_elimination;
1542 chain->need_reload = n_reloads > 0;
1543 chain->need_operand_change = operands_changed;
1544
1545 /* Discard any register replacements done. */
1546 if (did_elimination)
1547 {
1548 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_insn_firstobj);
1549 PATTERN (insn) = old_body;
1550 INSN_CODE (insn) = old_code;
1551 REG_NOTES (insn) = old_notes;
1552 something_needs_elimination = 1;
1553 }
1554
1555 something_needs_operands_changed |= operands_changed;
1556
1557 if (n_reloads != 0)
1558 {
1559 copy_reloads (chain);
1560 *pprev_reload = chain;
1561 pprev_reload = &chain->next_need_reload;
1562 }
1563 }
1564 }
1565 *pprev_reload = 0;
1566 }
1567
1568 /* Comparison function for qsort to decide which of two reloads
1569 should be handled first. *P1 and *P2 are the reload numbers. */
1570
1571 static int
reload_reg_class_lower(const void * r1p,const void * r2p)1572 reload_reg_class_lower (const void *r1p, const void *r2p)
1573 {
1574 int r1 = *(const short *) r1p, r2 = *(const short *) r2p;
1575 int t;
1576
1577 /* Consider required reloads before optional ones. */
1578 t = rld[r1].optional - rld[r2].optional;
1579 if (t != 0)
1580 return t;
1581
1582 /* Count all solitary classes before non-solitary ones. */
1583 t = ((reg_class_size[(int) rld[r2].class] == 1)
1584 - (reg_class_size[(int) rld[r1].class] == 1));
1585 if (t != 0)
1586 return t;
1587
1588 /* Aside from solitaires, consider all multi-reg groups first. */
1589 t = rld[r2].nregs - rld[r1].nregs;
1590 if (t != 0)
1591 return t;
1592
1593 /* Consider reloads in order of increasing reg-class number. */
1594 t = (int) rld[r1].class - (int) rld[r2].class;
1595 if (t != 0)
1596 return t;
1597
1598 /* If reloads are equally urgent, sort by reload number,
1599 so that the results of qsort leave nothing to chance. */
1600 return r1 - r2;
1601 }
1602
1603 /* The cost of spilling each hard reg. */
1604 static int spill_cost[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1605
1606 /* When spilling multiple hard registers, we use SPILL_COST for the first
1607 spilled hard reg and SPILL_ADD_COST for subsequent regs. SPILL_ADD_COST
1608 only the first hard reg for a multi-reg pseudo. */
1609 static int spill_add_cost[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1610
1611 /* Update the spill cost arrays, considering that pseudo REG is live. */
1612
1613 static void
count_pseudo(int reg)1614 count_pseudo (int reg)
1615 {
1616 int freq = REG_FREQ (reg);
1617 int r = reg_renumber[reg];
1618 int nregs;
1619
1620 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (&pseudos_counted, reg)
1621 || REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos, reg))
1622 return;
1623
1624 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted, reg);
1625
1626 gcc_assert (r >= 0);
1627
1628 spill_add_cost[r] += freq;
1629
1630 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[r][PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg)];
1631 while (nregs-- > 0)
1632 spill_cost[r + nregs] += freq;
1633 }
1634
1635 /* Calculate the SPILL_COST and SPILL_ADD_COST arrays and determine the
1636 contents of BAD_SPILL_REGS for the insn described by CHAIN. */
1637
1638 static void
order_regs_for_reload(struct insn_chain * chain)1639 order_regs_for_reload (struct insn_chain *chain)
1640 {
1641 unsigned i;
1642 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos;
1643 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2;
1644 reg_set_iterator rsi;
1645
1646 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, fixed_reg_set);
1647
1648 memset (spill_cost, 0, sizeof spill_cost);
1649 memset (spill_add_cost, 0, sizeof spill_add_cost);
1650
1651 /* Count number of uses of each hard reg by pseudo regs allocated to it
1652 and then order them by decreasing use. First exclude hard registers
1653 that are live in or across this insn. */
1654
1655 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
1656 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, &chain->dead_or_set);
1657 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos);
1658 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos2);
1659
1660 /* Now find out which pseudos are allocated to it, and update
1661 hard_reg_n_uses. */
1662 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
1663
1664 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1665 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
1666 {
1667 count_pseudo (i);
1668 }
1669 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1670 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
1671 {
1672 count_pseudo (i);
1673 }
1674 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
1675 }
1676
1677 /* Vector of reload-numbers showing the order in which the reloads should
1678 be processed. */
1679 static short reload_order[MAX_RELOADS];
1680
1681 /* This is used to keep track of the spill regs used in one insn. */
1682 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs_local;
1683
1684 /* We decided to spill hard register SPILLED, which has a size of
1685 SPILLED_NREGS. Determine how pseudo REG, which is live during the insn,
1686 is affected. We will add it to SPILLED_PSEUDOS if necessary, and we will
1687 update SPILL_COST/SPILL_ADD_COST. */
1688
1689 static void
count_spilled_pseudo(int spilled,int spilled_nregs,int reg)1690 count_spilled_pseudo (int spilled, int spilled_nregs, int reg)
1691 {
1692 int r = reg_renumber[reg];
1693 int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[r][PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg)];
1694
1695 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos, reg)
1696 || spilled + spilled_nregs <= r || r + nregs <= spilled)
1697 return;
1698
1699 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, reg);
1700
1701 spill_add_cost[r] -= REG_FREQ (reg);
1702 while (nregs-- > 0)
1703 spill_cost[r + nregs] -= REG_FREQ (reg);
1704 }
1705
1706 /* Find reload register to use for reload number ORDER. */
1707
1708 static int
find_reg(struct insn_chain * chain,int order)1709 find_reg (struct insn_chain *chain, int order)
1710 {
1711 int rnum = reload_order[order];
1712 struct reload *rl = rld + rnum;
1713 int best_cost = INT_MAX;
1714 int best_reg = -1;
1715 unsigned int i, j;
1716 int k;
1717 HARD_REG_SET not_usable;
1718 HARD_REG_SET used_by_other_reload;
1719 reg_set_iterator rsi;
1720
1721 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, bad_spill_regs);
1722 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, bad_spill_regs_global);
1723 IOR_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, reg_class_contents[rl->class]);
1724
1725 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_other_reload);
1726 for (k = 0; k < order; k++)
1727 {
1728 int other = reload_order[k];
1729
1730 if (rld[other].regno >= 0 && reloads_conflict (other, rnum))
1731 for (j = 0; j < rld[other].nregs; j++)
1732 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, rld[other].regno + j);
1733 }
1734
1735 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1736 {
1737 unsigned int regno = i;
1738
1739 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable, regno)
1740 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, regno)
1741 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rl->mode))
1742 {
1743 int this_cost = spill_cost[regno];
1744 int ok = 1;
1745 unsigned int this_nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][rl->mode];
1746
1747 for (j = 1; j < this_nregs; j++)
1748 {
1749 this_cost += spill_add_cost[regno + j];
1750 if ((TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable, regno + j))
1751 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, regno + j))
1752 ok = 0;
1753 }
1754 if (! ok)
1755 continue;
1756 if (rl->in && REG_P (rl->in) && REGNO (rl->in) == regno)
1757 this_cost--;
1758 if (rl->out && REG_P (rl->out) && REGNO (rl->out) == regno)
1759 this_cost--;
1760 if (this_cost < best_cost
1761 /* Among registers with equal cost, prefer caller-saved ones, or
1762 use REG_ALLOC_ORDER if it is defined. */
1763 || (this_cost == best_cost
1764 #ifdef REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1765 && (inv_reg_alloc_order[regno]
1766 < inv_reg_alloc_order[best_reg])
1767 #else
1768 && call_used_regs[regno]
1769 && ! call_used_regs[best_reg]
1770 #endif
1771 ))
1772 {
1773 best_reg = regno;
1774 best_cost = this_cost;
1775 }
1776 }
1777 }
1778 if (best_reg == -1)
1779 return 0;
1780
1781 if (dump_file)
1782 fprintf (dump_file, "Using reg %d for reload %d\n", best_reg, rnum);
1783
1784 rl->nregs = hard_regno_nregs[best_reg][rl->mode];
1785 rl->regno = best_reg;
1786
1787 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1788 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, j, rsi)
1789 {
1790 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg, rl->nregs, j);
1791 }
1792
1793 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1794 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, j, rsi)
1795 {
1796 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg, rl->nregs, j);
1797 }
1798
1799 for (i = 0; i < rl->nregs; i++)
1800 {
1801 gcc_assert (spill_cost[best_reg + i] == 0);
1802 gcc_assert (spill_add_cost[best_reg + i] == 0);
1803 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs_local, best_reg + i);
1804 }
1805 return 1;
1806 }
1807
1808 /* Find more reload regs to satisfy the remaining need of an insn, which
1809 is given by CHAIN.
1810 Do it by ascending class number, since otherwise a reg
1811 might be spilled for a big class and might fail to count
1812 for a smaller class even though it belongs to that class. */
1813
1814 static void
find_reload_regs(struct insn_chain * chain)1815 find_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *chain)
1816 {
1817 int i;
1818
1819 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
1820 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
1821 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
1822 that provided the reload registers. */
1823 for (i = 0; i < chain->n_reloads; i++)
1824 {
1825 /* Show whether this reload already has a hard reg. */
1826 if (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx)
1827 {
1828 int regno = REGNO (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx);
1829 chain->rld[i].regno = regno;
1830 chain->rld[i].nregs
1831 = hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx)];
1832 }
1833 else
1834 chain->rld[i].regno = -1;
1835 reload_order[i] = i;
1836 }
1837
1838 n_reloads = chain->n_reloads;
1839 memcpy (rld, chain->rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1840
1841 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs_local);
1842
1843 if (dump_file)
1844 fprintf (dump_file, "Spilling for insn %d.\n", INSN_UID (chain->insn));
1845
1846 qsort (reload_order, n_reloads, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower);
1847
1848 /* Compute the order of preference for hard registers to spill. */
1849
1850 order_regs_for_reload (chain);
1851
1852 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
1853 {
1854 int r = reload_order[i];
1855
1856 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
1857 if ((rld[r].out != 0 || rld[r].in != 0 || rld[r].secondary_p)
1858 && ! rld[r].optional
1859 && rld[r].regno == -1)
1860 if (! find_reg (chain, i))
1861 {
1862 if (dump_file)
1863 fprintf(dump_file, "reload failure for reload %d\n", r);
1864 spill_failure (chain->insn, rld[r].class);
1865 failure = 1;
1866 return;
1867 }
1868 }
1869
1870 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs_local);
1871 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs_local);
1872
1873 memcpy (chain->rld, rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1874 }
1875
1876 static void
select_reload_regs(void)1877 select_reload_regs (void)
1878 {
1879 struct insn_chain *chain;
1880
1881 /* Try to satisfy the needs for each insn. */
1882 for (chain = insns_need_reload; chain != 0;
1883 chain = chain->next_need_reload)
1884 find_reload_regs (chain);
1885 }
1886
1887 /* Delete all insns that were inserted by emit_caller_save_insns during
1888 this iteration. */
1889 static void
delete_caller_save_insns(void)1890 delete_caller_save_insns (void)
1891 {
1892 struct insn_chain *c = reload_insn_chain;
1893
1894 while (c != 0)
1895 {
1896 while (c != 0 && c->is_caller_save_insn)
1897 {
1898 struct insn_chain *next = c->next;
1899 rtx insn = c->insn;
1900
1901 if (c == reload_insn_chain)
1902 reload_insn_chain = next;
1903 delete_insn (insn);
1904
1905 if (next)
1906 next->prev = c->prev;
1907 if (c->prev)
1908 c->prev->next = next;
1909 c->next = unused_insn_chains;
1910 unused_insn_chains = c;
1911 c = next;
1912 }
1913 if (c != 0)
1914 c = c->next;
1915 }
1916 }
1917
1918 /* Handle the failure to find a register to spill.
1919 INSN should be one of the insns which needed this particular spill reg. */
1920
1921 static void
spill_failure(rtx insn,enum reg_class class)1922 spill_failure (rtx insn, enum reg_class class)
1923 {
1924 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
1925 error_for_asm (insn, "can't find a register in class %qs while "
1926 "reloading %<asm%>",
1927 reg_class_names[class]);
1928 else
1929 {
1930 error ("unable to find a register to spill in class %qs",
1931 reg_class_names[class]);
1932
1933 if (dump_file)
1934 {
1935 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReloads for insn # %d\n", INSN_UID (insn));
1936 debug_reload_to_stream (dump_file);
1937 }
1938 fatal_insn ("this is the insn:", insn);
1939 }
1940 }
1941
1942 /* Delete an unneeded INSN and any previous insns who sole purpose is loading
1943 data that is dead in INSN. */
1944
1945 static void
delete_dead_insn(rtx insn)1946 delete_dead_insn (rtx insn)
1947 {
1948 rtx prev = prev_real_insn (insn);
1949 rtx prev_dest;
1950
1951 /* If the previous insn sets a register that dies in our insn, delete it
1952 too. */
1953 if (prev && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SET
1954 && (prev_dest = SET_DEST (PATTERN (prev)), REG_P (prev_dest))
1955 && reg_mentioned_p (prev_dest, PATTERN (insn))
1956 && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (prev_dest))
1957 && ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (PATTERN (prev))))
1958 delete_dead_insn (prev);
1959
1960 SET_INSN_DELETED (insn);
1961 }
1962
1963 /* Modify the home of pseudo-reg I.
1964 The new home is present in reg_renumber[I].
1965
1966 FROM_REG may be the hard reg that the pseudo-reg is being spilled from;
1967 or it may be -1, meaning there is none or it is not relevant.
1968 This is used so that all pseudos spilled from a given hard reg
1969 can share one stack slot. */
1970
1971 static void
alter_reg(int i,int from_reg)1972 alter_reg (int i, int from_reg)
1973 {
1974 /* When outputting an inline function, this can happen
1975 for a reg that isn't actually used. */
1976 if (regno_reg_rtx[i] == 0)
1977 return;
1978
1979 /* If the reg got changed to a MEM at rtl-generation time,
1980 ignore it. */
1981 if (!REG_P (regno_reg_rtx[i]))
1982 return;
1983
1984 /* Modify the reg-rtx to contain the new hard reg
1985 number or else to contain its pseudo reg number. */
1986 REGNO (regno_reg_rtx[i])
1987 = reg_renumber[i] >= 0 ? reg_renumber[i] : i;
1988
1989 /* If we have a pseudo that is needed but has no hard reg or equivalent,
1990 allocate a stack slot for it. */
1991
1992 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0
1993 && REG_N_REFS (i) > 0
1994 && reg_equiv_constant[i] == 0
1995 && (reg_equiv_invariant[i] == 0 || reg_equiv_init[i] == 0)
1996 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] == 0)
1997 {
1998 rtx x;
1999 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]);
2000 unsigned int inherent_size = PSEUDO_REGNO_BYTES (i);
2001 unsigned int inherent_align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
2002 unsigned int total_size = MAX (inherent_size, reg_max_ref_width[i]);
2003 unsigned int min_align = reg_max_ref_width[i] * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2004 int adjust = 0;
2005
2006 /* Each pseudo reg has an inherent size which comes from its own mode,
2007 and a total size which provides room for paradoxical subregs
2008 which refer to the pseudo reg in wider modes.
2009
2010 We can use a slot already allocated if it provides both
2011 enough inherent space and enough total space.
2012 Otherwise, we allocate a new slot, making sure that it has no less
2013 inherent space, and no less total space, then the previous slot. */
2014 if (from_reg == -1)
2015 {
2016 /* No known place to spill from => no slot to reuse. */
2017 x = assign_stack_local (mode, total_size,
2018 min_align > inherent_align
2019 || total_size > inherent_size ? -1 : 0);
2020 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
2021 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
2022 Get the address of the beginning of the slot.
2023 This is so we can do a big-endian correction unconditionally
2024 below. */
2025 adjust = inherent_size - total_size;
2026
2027 /* Nothing can alias this slot except this pseudo. */
2028 set_mem_alias_set (x, new_alias_set ());
2029 }
2030
2031 /* Reuse a stack slot if possible. */
2032 else if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg] != 0
2033 && spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] >= total_size
2034 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
2035 >= inherent_size)
2036 && MEM_ALIGN (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]) >= min_align)
2037 x = spill_stack_slot[from_reg];
2038
2039 /* Allocate a bigger slot. */
2040 else
2041 {
2042 /* Compute maximum size needed, both for inherent size
2043 and for total size. */
2044 rtx stack_slot;
2045
2046 if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg])
2047 {
2048 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
2049 > inherent_size)
2050 mode = GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]);
2051 if (spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] > total_size)
2052 total_size = spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg];
2053 if (MEM_ALIGN (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]) > min_align)
2054 min_align = MEM_ALIGN (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]);
2055 }
2056
2057 /* Make a slot with that size. */
2058 x = assign_stack_local (mode, total_size,
2059 min_align > inherent_align
2060 || total_size > inherent_size ? -1 : 0);
2061 stack_slot = x;
2062
2063 /* All pseudos mapped to this slot can alias each other. */
2064 if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg])
2065 set_mem_alias_set (x, MEM_ALIAS_SET (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]));
2066 else
2067 set_mem_alias_set (x, new_alias_set ());
2068
2069 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
2070 {
2071 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
2072 Get the address of the beginning of the slot.
2073 This is so we can do a big-endian correction unconditionally
2074 below. */
2075 adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - total_size;
2076 if (adjust)
2077 stack_slot
2078 = adjust_address_nv (x, mode_for_size (total_size
2079 * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2080 MODE_INT, 1),
2081 adjust);
2082 }
2083
2084 spill_stack_slot[from_reg] = stack_slot;
2085 spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] = total_size;
2086 }
2087
2088 /* On a big endian machine, the "address" of the slot
2089 is the address of the low part that fits its inherent mode. */
2090 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && inherent_size < total_size)
2091 adjust += (total_size - inherent_size);
2092
2093 /* If we have any adjustment to make, or if the stack slot is the
2094 wrong mode, make a new stack slot. */
2095 x = adjust_address_nv (x, GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]), adjust);
2096
2097 /* If we have a decl for the original register, set it for the
2098 memory. If this is a shared MEM, make a copy. */
2099 if (REG_EXPR (regno_reg_rtx[i])
2100 && DECL_P (REG_EXPR (regno_reg_rtx[i])))
2101 {
2102 rtx decl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (REG_EXPR (regno_reg_rtx[i]));
2103
2104 /* We can do this only for the DECLs home pseudo, not for
2105 any copies of it, since otherwise when the stack slot
2106 is reused, nonoverlapping_memrefs_p might think they
2107 cannot overlap. */
2108 if (decl && REG_P (decl) && REGNO (decl) == (unsigned) i)
2109 {
2110 if (from_reg != -1 && spill_stack_slot[from_reg] == x)
2111 x = copy_rtx (x);
2112
2113 set_mem_attrs_from_reg (x, regno_reg_rtx[i]);
2114 }
2115 }
2116
2117 /* Save the stack slot for later. */
2118 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = x;
2119 }
2120 }
2121
2122 /* Mark the slots in regs_ever_live for the hard regs
2123 used by pseudo-reg number REGNO. */
2124
2125 void
mark_home_live(int regno)2126 mark_home_live (int regno)
2127 {
2128 int i, lim;
2129
2130 i = reg_renumber[regno];
2131 if (i < 0)
2132 return;
2133 lim = i + hard_regno_nregs[i][PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno)];
2134 while (i < lim)
2135 regs_ever_live[i++] = 1;
2136 }
2137
2138 /* This function handles the tracking of elimination offsets around branches.
2139
2140 X is a piece of RTL being scanned.
2141
2142 INSN is the insn that it came from, if any.
2143
2144 INITIAL_P is nonzero if we are to set the offset to be the initial
2145 offset and zero if we are setting the offset of the label to be the
2146 current offset. */
2147
2148 static void
set_label_offsets(rtx x,rtx insn,int initial_p)2149 set_label_offsets (rtx x, rtx insn, int initial_p)
2150 {
2151 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2152 rtx tem;
2153 unsigned int i;
2154 struct elim_table *p;
2155
2156 switch (code)
2157 {
2158 case LABEL_REF:
2159 if (LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (x))
2160 return;
2161
2162 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2163
2164 /* ... fall through ... */
2165
2166 case CODE_LABEL:
2167 /* If we know nothing about this label, set the desired offsets. Note
2168 that this sets the offset at a label to be the offset before a label
2169 if we don't know anything about the label. This is not correct for
2170 the label after a BARRIER, but is the best guess we can make. If
2171 we guessed wrong, we will suppress an elimination that might have
2172 been possible had we been able to guess correctly. */
2173
2174 if (! offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num])
2175 {
2176 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
2177 offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num][i]
2178 = (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
2179 : reg_eliminate[i].offset);
2180 offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num] = 1;
2181 }
2182
2183 /* Otherwise, if this is the definition of a label and it is
2184 preceded by a BARRIER, set our offsets to the known offset of
2185 that label. */
2186
2187 else if (x == insn
2188 && (tem = prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) != 0
2189 && BARRIER_P (tem))
2190 set_offsets_for_label (insn);
2191 else
2192 /* If neither of the above cases is true, compare each offset
2193 with those previously recorded and suppress any eliminations
2194 where the offsets disagree. */
2195
2196 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
2197 if (offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num][i]
2198 != (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
2199 : reg_eliminate[i].offset))
2200 reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;
2201
2202 return;
2203
2204 case JUMP_INSN:
2205 set_label_offsets (PATTERN (insn), insn, initial_p);
2206
2207 /* ... fall through ... */
2208
2209 case INSN:
2210 case CALL_INSN:
2211 /* Any labels mentioned in REG_LABEL notes can be branched to indirectly
2212 and hence must have all eliminations at their initial offsets. */
2213 for (tem = REG_NOTES (x); tem; tem = XEXP (tem, 1))
2214 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (tem) == REG_LABEL)
2215 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, 1);
2216 return;
2217
2218 case PARALLEL:
2219 case ADDR_VEC:
2220 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2221 /* Each of the labels in the parallel or address vector must be
2222 at their initial offsets. We want the first field for PARALLEL
2223 and ADDR_VEC and the second field for ADDR_DIFF_VEC. */
2224
2225 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned) XVECLEN (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC); i++)
2226 set_label_offsets (XVECEXP (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC, i),
2227 insn, initial_p);
2228 return;
2229
2230 case SET:
2231 /* We only care about setting PC. If the source is not RETURN,
2232 IF_THEN_ELSE, or a label, disable any eliminations not at
2233 their initial offsets. Similarly if any arm of the IF_THEN_ELSE
2234 isn't one of those possibilities. For branches to a label,
2235 call ourselves recursively.
2236
2237 Note that this can disable elimination unnecessarily when we have
2238 a non-local goto since it will look like a non-constant jump to
2239 someplace in the current function. This isn't a significant
2240 problem since such jumps will normally be when all elimination
2241 pairs are back to their initial offsets. */
2242
2243 if (SET_DEST (x) != pc_rtx)
2244 return;
2245
2246 switch (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)))
2247 {
2248 case PC:
2249 case RETURN:
2250 return;
2251
2252 case LABEL_REF:
2253 set_label_offsets (SET_SRC (x), insn, initial_p);
2254 return;
2255
2256 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
2257 tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1);
2258 if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
2259 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
2260 else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
2261 break;
2262
2263 tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 2);
2264 if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
2265 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
2266 else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
2267 break;
2268 return;
2269
2270 default:
2271 break;
2272 }
2273
2274 /* If we reach here, all eliminations must be at their initial
2275 offset because we are doing a jump to a variable address. */
2276 for (p = reg_eliminate; p < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; p++)
2277 if (p->offset != p->initial_offset)
2278 p->can_eliminate = 0;
2279 break;
2280
2281 default:
2282 break;
2283 }
2284 }
2285
2286 /* Scan X and replace any eliminable registers (such as fp) with a
2287 replacement (such as sp), plus an offset.
2288
2289 MEM_MODE is the mode of an enclosing MEM. We need this to know how
2290 much to adjust a register for, e.g., PRE_DEC. Also, if we are inside a
2291 MEM, we are allowed to replace a sum of a register and the constant zero
2292 with the register, which we cannot do outside a MEM. In addition, we need
2293 to record the fact that a register is referenced outside a MEM.
2294
2295 If INSN is an insn, it is the insn containing X. If we replace a REG
2296 in a SET_DEST with an equivalent MEM and INSN is nonzero, write a
2297 CLOBBER of the pseudo after INSN so find_equiv_regs will know that
2298 the REG is being modified.
2299
2300 Alternatively, INSN may be a note (an EXPR_LIST or INSN_LIST).
2301 That's used when we eliminate in expressions stored in notes.
2302 This means, do not set ref_outside_mem even if the reference
2303 is outside of MEMs.
2304
2305 REG_EQUIV_MEM and REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS contain address that have had
2306 replacements done assuming all offsets are at their initial values. If
2307 they are not, or if REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS is nonzero for a pseudo we
2308 encounter, return the actual location so that find_reloads will do
2309 the proper thing. */
2310
2311 static rtx
eliminate_regs_1(rtx x,enum machine_mode mem_mode,rtx insn,bool may_use_invariant)2312 eliminate_regs_1 (rtx x, enum machine_mode mem_mode, rtx insn,
2313 bool may_use_invariant)
2314 {
2315 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2316 struct elim_table *ep;
2317 int regno;
2318 rtx new;
2319 int i, j;
2320 const char *fmt;
2321 int copied = 0;
2322
2323 if (! current_function_decl)
2324 return x;
2325
2326 switch (code)
2327 {
2328 case CONST_INT:
2329 case CONST_DOUBLE:
2330 case CONST_VECTOR:
2331 case CONST:
2332 case SYMBOL_REF:
2333 case CODE_LABEL:
2334 case PC:
2335 case CC0:
2336 case ASM_INPUT:
2337 case ADDR_VEC:
2338 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2339 case RETURN:
2340 return x;
2341
2342 case REG:
2343 regno = REGNO (x);
2344
2345 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2346 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2347 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2348 {
2349 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2350 ep++)
2351 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2352 return plus_constant (ep->to_rtx, ep->previous_offset);
2353
2354 }
2355 else if (reg_renumber && reg_renumber[regno] < 0
2356 && reg_equiv_invariant && reg_equiv_invariant[regno])
2357 {
2358 if (may_use_invariant)
2359 return eliminate_regs_1 (copy_rtx (reg_equiv_invariant[regno]),
2360 mem_mode, insn, true);
2361 /* There exists at least one use of REGNO that cannot be
2362 eliminated. Prevent the defining insn from being deleted. */
2363 reg_equiv_init[regno] = NULL_RTX;
2364 alter_reg (regno, -1);
2365 }
2366 return x;
2367
2368 /* You might think handling MINUS in a manner similar to PLUS is a
2369 good idea. It is not. It has been tried multiple times and every
2370 time the change has had to have been reverted.
2371
2372 Other parts of reload know a PLUS is special (gen_reload for example)
2373 and require special code to handle code a reloaded PLUS operand.
2374
2375 Also consider backends where the flags register is clobbered by a
2376 MINUS, but we can emit a PLUS that does not clobber flags (IA-32,
2377 lea instruction comes to mind). If we try to reload a MINUS, we
2378 may kill the flags register that was holding a useful value.
2379
2380 So, please before trying to handle MINUS, consider reload as a
2381 whole instead of this little section as well as the backend issues. */
2382 case PLUS:
2383 /* If this is the sum of an eliminable register and a constant, rework
2384 the sum. */
2385 if (REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
2386 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2387 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
2388 {
2389 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2390 ep++)
2391 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
2392 {
2393 /* The only time we want to replace a PLUS with a REG (this
2394 occurs when the constant operand of the PLUS is the negative
2395 of the offset) is when we are inside a MEM. We won't want
2396 to do so at other times because that would change the
2397 structure of the insn in a way that reload can't handle.
2398 We special-case the commonest situation in
2399 eliminate_regs_in_insn, so just replace a PLUS with a
2400 PLUS here, unless inside a MEM. */
2401 if (mem_mode != 0 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
2402 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) == - ep->previous_offset)
2403 return ep->to_rtx;
2404 else
2405 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, ep->to_rtx,
2406 plus_constant (XEXP (x, 1),
2407 ep->previous_offset));
2408 }
2409
2410 /* If the register is not eliminable, we are done since the other
2411 operand is a constant. */
2412 return x;
2413 }
2414
2415 /* If this is part of an address, we want to bring any constant to the
2416 outermost PLUS. We will do this by doing register replacement in
2417 our operands and seeing if a constant shows up in one of them.
2418
2419 Note that there is no risk of modifying the structure of the insn,
2420 since we only get called for its operands, thus we are either
2421 modifying the address inside a MEM, or something like an address
2422 operand of a load-address insn. */
2423
2424 {
2425 rtx new0 = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, true);
2426 rtx new1 = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, true);
2427
2428 if (reg_renumber && (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1)))
2429 {
2430 /* If one side is a PLUS and the other side is a pseudo that
2431 didn't get a hard register but has a reg_equiv_constant,
2432 we must replace the constant here since it may no longer
2433 be in the position of any operand. */
2434 if (GET_CODE (new0) == PLUS && REG_P (new1)
2435 && REGNO (new1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2436 && reg_renumber[REGNO (new1)] < 0
2437 && reg_equiv_constant != 0
2438 && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new1)] != 0)
2439 new1 = reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new1)];
2440 else if (GET_CODE (new1) == PLUS && REG_P (new0)
2441 && REGNO (new0) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2442 && reg_renumber[REGNO (new0)] < 0
2443 && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new0)] != 0)
2444 new0 = reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new0)];
2445
2446 new = form_sum (new0, new1);
2447
2448 /* As above, if we are not inside a MEM we do not want to
2449 turn a PLUS into something else. We might try to do so here
2450 for an addition of 0 if we aren't optimizing. */
2451 if (! mem_mode && GET_CODE (new) != PLUS)
2452 return gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x), new, const0_rtx);
2453 else
2454 return new;
2455 }
2456 }
2457 return x;
2458
2459 case MULT:
2460 /* If this is the product of an eliminable register and a
2461 constant, apply the distribute law and move the constant out
2462 so that we have (plus (mult ..) ..). This is needed in order
2463 to keep load-address insns valid. This case is pathological.
2464 We ignore the possibility of overflow here. */
2465 if (REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
2466 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2467 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
2468 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2469 ep++)
2470 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
2471 {
2472 if (! mem_mode
2473 /* Refs inside notes don't count for this purpose. */
2474 && ! (insn != 0 && (GET_CODE (insn) == EXPR_LIST
2475 || GET_CODE (insn) == INSN_LIST)))
2476 ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;
2477
2478 return
2479 plus_constant (gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, ep->to_rtx, XEXP (x, 1)),
2480 ep->previous_offset * INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)));
2481 }
2482
2483 /* ... fall through ... */
2484
2485 case CALL:
2486 case COMPARE:
2487 /* See comments before PLUS about handling MINUS. */
2488 case MINUS:
2489 case DIV: case UDIV:
2490 case MOD: case UMOD:
2491 case AND: case IOR: case XOR:
2492 case ROTATERT: case ROTATE:
2493 case ASHIFTRT: case LSHIFTRT: case ASHIFT:
2494 case NE: case EQ:
2495 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
2496 case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
2497 {
2498 rtx new0 = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, false);
2499 rtx new1 = XEXP (x, 1)
2500 ? eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, false) : 0;
2501
2502 if (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1))
2503 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, GET_MODE (x), new0, new1);
2504 }
2505 return x;
2506
2507 case EXPR_LIST:
2508 /* If we have something in XEXP (x, 0), the usual case, eliminate it. */
2509 if (XEXP (x, 0))
2510 {
2511 new = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, true);
2512 if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
2513 {
2514 /* If this is a REG_DEAD note, it is not valid anymore.
2515 Using the eliminated version could result in creating a
2516 REG_DEAD note for the stack or frame pointer. */
2517 if (GET_MODE (x) == REG_DEAD)
2518 return (XEXP (x, 1)
2519 ? eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, true)
2520 : NULL_RTX);
2521
2522 x = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (x), new, XEXP (x, 1));
2523 }
2524 }
2525
2526 /* ... fall through ... */
2527
2528 case INSN_LIST:
2529 /* Now do eliminations in the rest of the chain. If this was
2530 an EXPR_LIST, this might result in allocating more memory than is
2531 strictly needed, but it simplifies the code. */
2532 if (XEXP (x, 1))
2533 {
2534 new = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, true);
2535 if (new != XEXP (x, 1))
2536 return
2537 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (x), GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0), new);
2538 }
2539 return x;
2540
2541 case PRE_INC:
2542 case POST_INC:
2543 case PRE_DEC:
2544 case POST_DEC:
2545 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
2546 case NEG: case NOT:
2547 case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
2548 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
2549 case FLOAT: case FIX:
2550 case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
2551 case ABS:
2552 case SQRT:
2553 case FFS:
2554 case CLZ:
2555 case CTZ:
2556 case POPCOUNT:
2557 case PARITY:
2558 new = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, false);
2559 if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
2560 return gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, GET_MODE (x), new);
2561 return x;
2562
2563 case SUBREG:
2564 /* Similar to above processing, but preserve SUBREG_BYTE.
2565 Convert (subreg (mem)) to (mem) if not paradoxical.
2566 Also, if we have a non-paradoxical (subreg (pseudo)) and the
2567 pseudo didn't get a hard reg, we must replace this with the
2568 eliminated version of the memory location because push_reload
2569 may do the replacement in certain circumstances. */
2570 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
2571 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
2572 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
2573 && reg_equiv_memory_loc != 0
2574 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))] != 0)
2575 {
2576 new = SUBREG_REG (x);
2577 }
2578 else
2579 new = eliminate_regs_1 (SUBREG_REG (x), mem_mode, insn, false);
2580
2581 if (new != SUBREG_REG (x))
2582 {
2583 int x_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
2584 int new_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (new));
2585
2586 if (MEM_P (new)
2587 && ((x_size < new_size
2588 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
2589 /* On these machines, combine can create rtl of the form
2590 (set (subreg:m1 (reg:m2 R) 0) ...)
2591 where m1 < m2, and expects something interesting to
2592 happen to the entire word. Moreover, it will use the
2593 (reg:m2 R) later, expecting all bits to be preserved.
2594 So if the number of words is the same, preserve the
2595 subreg so that push_reload can see it. */
2596 && ! ((x_size - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD
2597 == (new_size -1 ) / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2598 #endif
2599 )
2600 || x_size == new_size)
2601 )
2602 return adjust_address_nv (new, GET_MODE (x), SUBREG_BYTE (x));
2603 else
2604 return gen_rtx_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x), new, SUBREG_BYTE (x));
2605 }
2606
2607 return x;
2608
2609 case MEM:
2610 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
2611 recursive call and copy the flags. While we are here, handle this
2612 case more efficiently. */
2613 return
2614 replace_equiv_address_nv (x,
2615 eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x),
2616 insn, true));
2617
2618 case USE:
2619 /* Handle insn_list USE that a call to a pure function may generate. */
2620 new = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), 0, insn, false);
2621 if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
2622 return gen_rtx_USE (GET_MODE (x), new);
2623 return x;
2624
2625 case CLOBBER:
2626 case ASM_OPERANDS:
2627 case SET:
2628 gcc_unreachable ();
2629
2630 default:
2631 break;
2632 }
2633
2634 /* Process each of our operands recursively. If any have changed, make a
2635 copy of the rtx. */
2636 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
2637 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
2638 {
2639 if (*fmt == 'e')
2640 {
2641 new = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, i), mem_mode, insn, false);
2642 if (new != XEXP (x, i) && ! copied)
2643 {
2644 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
2645 copied = 1;
2646 }
2647 XEXP (x, i) = new;
2648 }
2649 else if (*fmt == 'E')
2650 {
2651 int copied_vec = 0;
2652 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
2653 {
2654 new = eliminate_regs_1 (XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode, insn, false);
2655 if (new != XVECEXP (x, i, j) && ! copied_vec)
2656 {
2657 rtvec new_v = gen_rtvec_v (XVECLEN (x, i),
2658 XVEC (x, i)->elem);
2659 if (! copied)
2660 {
2661 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
2662 copied = 1;
2663 }
2664 XVEC (x, i) = new_v;
2665 copied_vec = 1;
2666 }
2667 XVECEXP (x, i, j) = new;
2668 }
2669 }
2670 }
2671
2672 return x;
2673 }
2674
2675 rtx
eliminate_regs(rtx x,enum machine_mode mem_mode,rtx insn)2676 eliminate_regs (rtx x, enum machine_mode mem_mode, rtx insn)
2677 {
2678 return eliminate_regs_1 (x, mem_mode, insn, false);
2679 }
2680
2681 /* Scan rtx X for modifications of elimination target registers. Update
2682 the table of eliminables to reflect the changed state. MEM_MODE is
2683 the mode of an enclosing MEM rtx, or VOIDmode if not within a MEM. */
2684
2685 static void
elimination_effects(rtx x,enum machine_mode mem_mode)2686 elimination_effects (rtx x, enum machine_mode mem_mode)
2687 {
2688 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2689 struct elim_table *ep;
2690 int regno;
2691 int i, j;
2692 const char *fmt;
2693
2694 switch (code)
2695 {
2696 case CONST_INT:
2697 case CONST_DOUBLE:
2698 case CONST_VECTOR:
2699 case CONST:
2700 case SYMBOL_REF:
2701 case CODE_LABEL:
2702 case PC:
2703 case CC0:
2704 case ASM_INPUT:
2705 case ADDR_VEC:
2706 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2707 case RETURN:
2708 return;
2709
2710 case REG:
2711 regno = REGNO (x);
2712
2713 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2714 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2715 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2716 {
2717 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2718 ep++)
2719 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2720 {
2721 if (! mem_mode)
2722 ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;
2723 return;
2724 }
2725
2726 }
2727 else if (reg_renumber[regno] < 0 && reg_equiv_constant
2728 && reg_equiv_constant[regno]
2729 && ! function_invariant_p (reg_equiv_constant[regno]))
2730 elimination_effects (reg_equiv_constant[regno], mem_mode);
2731 return;
2732
2733 case PRE_INC:
2734 case POST_INC:
2735 case PRE_DEC:
2736 case POST_DEC:
2737 case POST_MODIFY:
2738 case PRE_MODIFY:
2739 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2740 if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
2741 {
2742 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mem_mode);
2743
2744 /* If more bytes than MEM_MODE are pushed, account for them. */
2745 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
2746 if (ep->to_rtx == stack_pointer_rtx)
2747 size = PUSH_ROUNDING (size);
2748 #endif
2749 if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
2750 ep->offset += size;
2751 else if (code == PRE_INC || code == POST_INC)
2752 ep->offset -= size;
2753 else if ((code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
2754 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == PLUS
2755 && XEXP (x, 0) == XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0)
2756 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1)))
2757 ep->offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1));
2758 }
2759
2760 /* These two aren't unary operators. */
2761 if (code == POST_MODIFY || code == PRE_MODIFY)
2762 break;
2763
2764 /* Fall through to generic unary operation case. */
2765 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
2766 case NEG: case NOT:
2767 case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
2768 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
2769 case FLOAT: case FIX:
2770 case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
2771 case ABS:
2772 case SQRT:
2773 case FFS:
2774 case CLZ:
2775 case CTZ:
2776 case POPCOUNT:
2777 case PARITY:
2778 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
2779 return;
2780
2781 case SUBREG:
2782 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
2783 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
2784 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
2785 && reg_equiv_memory_loc != 0
2786 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))] != 0)
2787 return;
2788
2789 elimination_effects (SUBREG_REG (x), mem_mode);
2790 return;
2791
2792 case USE:
2793 /* If using a register that is the source of an eliminate we still
2794 think can be performed, note it cannot be performed since we don't
2795 know how this register is used. */
2796 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2797 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
2798 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2799
2800 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
2801 return;
2802
2803 case CLOBBER:
2804 /* If clobbering a register that is the replacement register for an
2805 elimination we still think can be performed, note that it cannot
2806 be performed. Otherwise, we need not be concerned about it. */
2807 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2808 if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
2809 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2810
2811 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
2812 return;
2813
2814 case SET:
2815 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
2816 if (REG_P (SET_DEST (x)))
2817 {
2818 /* See if this is setting the replacement register for an
2819 elimination.
2820
2821 If DEST is the hard frame pointer, we do nothing because we
2822 assume that all assignments to the frame pointer are for
2823 non-local gotos and are being done at a time when they are valid
2824 and do not disturb anything else. Some machines want to
2825 eliminate a fake argument pointer (or even a fake frame pointer)
2826 with either the real frame or the stack pointer. Assignments to
2827 the hard frame pointer must not prevent this elimination. */
2828
2829 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2830 ep++)
2831 if (ep->to_rtx == SET_DEST (x)
2832 && SET_DEST (x) != hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2833 {
2834 /* If it is being incremented, adjust the offset. Otherwise,
2835 this elimination can't be done. */
2836 rtx src = SET_SRC (x);
2837
2838 if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
2839 && XEXP (src, 0) == SET_DEST (x)
2840 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
2841 ep->offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2842 else
2843 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2844 }
2845 }
2846
2847 elimination_effects (SET_DEST (x), 0);
2848 elimination_effects (SET_SRC (x), 0);
2849 return;
2850
2851 case MEM:
2852 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
2853 recursive call. */
2854 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x));
2855 return;
2856
2857 default:
2858 break;
2859 }
2860
2861 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
2862 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
2863 {
2864 if (*fmt == 'e')
2865 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, i), mem_mode);
2866 else if (*fmt == 'E')
2867 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
2868 elimination_effects (XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode);
2869 }
2870 }
2871
2872 /* Descend through rtx X and verify that no references to eliminable registers
2873 remain. If any do remain, mark the involved register as not
2874 eliminable. */
2875
2876 static void
check_eliminable_occurrences(rtx x)2877 check_eliminable_occurrences (rtx x)
2878 {
2879 const char *fmt;
2880 int i;
2881 enum rtx_code code;
2882
2883 if (x == 0)
2884 return;
2885
2886 code = GET_CODE (x);
2887
2888 if (code == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2889 {
2890 struct elim_table *ep;
2891
2892 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2893 if (ep->from_rtx == x)
2894 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2895 return;
2896 }
2897
2898 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
2899 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
2900 {
2901 if (*fmt == 'e')
2902 check_eliminable_occurrences (XEXP (x, i));
2903 else if (*fmt == 'E')
2904 {
2905 int j;
2906 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
2907 check_eliminable_occurrences (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
2908 }
2909 }
2910 }
2911
2912 /* Scan INSN and eliminate all eliminable registers in it.
2913
2914 If REPLACE is nonzero, do the replacement destructively. Also
2915 delete the insn as dead it if it is setting an eliminable register.
2916
2917 If REPLACE is zero, do all our allocations in reload_obstack.
2918
2919 If no eliminations were done and this insn doesn't require any elimination
2920 processing (these are not identical conditions: it might be updating sp,
2921 but not referencing fp; this needs to be seen during reload_as_needed so
2922 that the offset between fp and sp can be taken into consideration), zero
2923 is returned. Otherwise, 1 is returned. */
2924
2925 static int
eliminate_regs_in_insn(rtx insn,int replace)2926 eliminate_regs_in_insn (rtx insn, int replace)
2927 {
2928 int icode = recog_memoized (insn);
2929 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
2930 int insn_is_asm = asm_noperands (old_body) >= 0;
2931 rtx old_set = single_set (insn);
2932 rtx new_body;
2933 int val = 0;
2934 int i;
2935 rtx substed_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
2936 rtx orig_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
2937 struct elim_table *ep;
2938 rtx plus_src, plus_cst_src;
2939
2940 if (! insn_is_asm && icode < 0)
2941 {
2942 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
2943 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
2944 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_VEC
2945 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC
2946 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ASM_INPUT);
2947 return 0;
2948 }
2949
2950 if (old_set != 0 && REG_P (SET_DEST (old_set))
2951 && REGNO (SET_DEST (old_set)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2952 {
2953 /* Check for setting an eliminable register. */
2954 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2955 if (ep->from_rtx == SET_DEST (old_set) && ep->can_eliminate)
2956 {
2957 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2958 /* If this is setting the frame pointer register to the
2959 hardware frame pointer register and this is an elimination
2960 that will be done (tested above), this insn is really
2961 adjusting the frame pointer downward to compensate for
2962 the adjustment done before a nonlocal goto. */
2963 if (ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2964 && ep->to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2965 {
2966 rtx base = SET_SRC (old_set);
2967 rtx base_insn = insn;
2968 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
2969
2970 while (base != ep->to_rtx)
2971 {
2972 rtx prev_insn, prev_set;
2973
2974 if (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS
2975 && GET_CODE (XEXP (base, 1)) == CONST_INT)
2976 {
2977 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1));
2978 base = XEXP (base, 0);
2979 }
2980 else if ((prev_insn = prev_nonnote_insn (base_insn)) != 0
2981 && (prev_set = single_set (prev_insn)) != 0
2982 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (prev_set), base))
2983 {
2984 base = SET_SRC (prev_set);
2985 base_insn = prev_insn;
2986 }
2987 else
2988 break;
2989 }
2990
2991 if (base == ep->to_rtx)
2992 {
2993 rtx src
2994 = plus_constant (ep->to_rtx, offset - ep->offset);
2995
2996 new_body = old_body;
2997 if (! replace)
2998 {
2999 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3000 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3001 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3002 }
3003 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3004 old_set = single_set (insn);
3005
3006 /* First see if this insn remains valid when we
3007 make the change. If not, keep the INSN_CODE
3008 the same and let reload fit it up. */
3009 validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (old_set), src, 1);
3010 validate_change (insn, &SET_DEST (old_set),
3011 ep->to_rtx, 1);
3012 if (! apply_change_group ())
3013 {
3014 SET_SRC (old_set) = src;
3015 SET_DEST (old_set) = ep->to_rtx;
3016 }
3017
3018 val = 1;
3019 goto done;
3020 }
3021 }
3022 #endif
3023
3024 /* In this case this insn isn't serving a useful purpose. We
3025 will delete it in reload_as_needed once we know that this
3026 elimination is, in fact, being done.
3027
3028 If REPLACE isn't set, we can't delete this insn, but needn't
3029 process it since it won't be used unless something changes. */
3030 if (replace)
3031 {
3032 delete_dead_insn (insn);
3033 return 1;
3034 }
3035 val = 1;
3036 goto done;
3037 }
3038 }
3039
3040 /* We allow one special case which happens to work on all machines we
3041 currently support: a single set with the source or a REG_EQUAL
3042 note being a PLUS of an eliminable register and a constant. */
3043 plus_src = plus_cst_src = 0;
3044 if (old_set && REG_P (SET_DEST (old_set)))
3045 {
3046 if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS)
3047 plus_src = SET_SRC (old_set);
3048 /* First see if the source is of the form (plus (...) CST). */
3049 if (plus_src
3050 && GET_CODE (XEXP (plus_src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
3051 plus_cst_src = plus_src;
3052 else if (REG_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3053 || plus_src)
3054 {
3055 /* Otherwise, see if we have a REG_EQUAL note of the form
3056 (plus (...) CST). */
3057 rtx links;
3058 for (links = REG_NOTES (insn); links; links = XEXP (links, 1))
3059 {
3060 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (links) == REG_EQUAL
3061 && GET_CODE (XEXP (links, 0)) == PLUS
3062 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (links, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)
3063 {
3064 plus_cst_src = XEXP (links, 0);
3065 break;
3066 }
3067 }
3068 }
3069
3070 /* Check that the first operand of the PLUS is a hard reg or
3071 the lowpart subreg of one. */
3072 if (plus_cst_src)
3073 {
3074 rtx reg = XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0);
3075 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG && subreg_lowpart_p (reg))
3076 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
3077
3078 if (!REG_P (reg) || REGNO (reg) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3079 plus_cst_src = 0;
3080 }
3081 }
3082 if (plus_cst_src)
3083 {
3084 rtx reg = XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0);
3085 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = INTVAL (XEXP (plus_cst_src, 1));
3086
3087 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
3088 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
3089
3090 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3091 if (ep->from_rtx == reg && ep->can_eliminate)
3092 {
3093 rtx to_rtx = ep->to_rtx;
3094 offset += ep->offset;
3095 offset = trunc_int_for_mode (offset, GET_MODE (reg));
3096
3097 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0)) == SUBREG)
3098 to_rtx = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0)),
3099 to_rtx);
3100 /* If we have a nonzero offset, and the source is already
3101 a simple REG, the following transformation would
3102 increase the cost of the insn by replacing a simple REG
3103 with (plus (reg sp) CST). So try only when we already
3104 had a PLUS before. */
3105 if (offset == 0 || plus_src)
3106 {
3107 rtx new_src = plus_constant (to_rtx, offset);
3108
3109 new_body = old_body;
3110 if (! replace)
3111 {
3112 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3113 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3114 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3115 }
3116 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3117 old_set = single_set (insn);
3118
3119 /* First see if this insn remains valid when we make the
3120 change. If not, try to replace the whole pattern with
3121 a simple set (this may help if the original insn was a
3122 PARALLEL that was only recognized as single_set due to
3123 REG_UNUSED notes). If this isn't valid either, keep
3124 the INSN_CODE the same and let reload fix it up. */
3125 if (!validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (old_set), new_src, 0))
3126 {
3127 rtx new_pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
3128 SET_DEST (old_set), new_src);
3129
3130 if (!validate_change (insn, &PATTERN (insn), new_pat, 0))
3131 SET_SRC (old_set) = new_src;
3132 }
3133 }
3134 else
3135 break;
3136
3137 val = 1;
3138 /* This can't have an effect on elimination offsets, so skip right
3139 to the end. */
3140 goto done;
3141 }
3142 }
3143
3144 /* Determine the effects of this insn on elimination offsets. */
3145 elimination_effects (old_body, 0);
3146
3147 /* Eliminate all eliminable registers occurring in operands that
3148 can be handled by reload. */
3149 extract_insn (insn);
3150 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3151 {
3152 orig_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3153 substed_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3154
3155 /* For an asm statement, every operand is eliminable. */
3156 if (insn_is_asm || insn_data[icode].operand[i].eliminable)
3157 {
3158 bool is_set_src, in_plus;
3159
3160 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
3161 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3162 && REG_P (orig_operand[i]))
3163 {
3164 /* If we are assigning to a register that can be eliminated, it
3165 must be as part of a PARALLEL, since the code above handles
3166 single SETs. We must indicate that we can no longer
3167 eliminate this reg. */
3168 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
3169 ep++)
3170 if (ep->from_rtx == orig_operand[i])
3171 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3172 }
3173
3174 /* Companion to the above plus substitution, we can allow
3175 invariants as the source of a plain move. */
3176 is_set_src = false;
3177 if (old_set && recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &SET_SRC (old_set))
3178 is_set_src = true;
3179 in_plus = false;
3180 if (plus_src
3181 && (recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &XEXP (plus_src, 0)
3182 || recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &XEXP (plus_src, 1)))
3183 in_plus = true;
3184
3185 substed_operand[i]
3186 = eliminate_regs_1 (recog_data.operand[i], 0,
3187 replace ? insn : NULL_RTX,
3188 is_set_src || in_plus);
3189 if (substed_operand[i] != orig_operand[i])
3190 val = 1;
3191 /* Terminate the search in check_eliminable_occurrences at
3192 this point. */
3193 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = 0;
3194
3195 /* If an output operand changed from a REG to a MEM and INSN is an
3196 insn, write a CLOBBER insn. */
3197 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3198 && REG_P (orig_operand[i])
3199 && MEM_P (substed_operand[i])
3200 && replace)
3201 emit_insn_after (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, orig_operand[i]),
3202 insn);
3203 }
3204 }
3205
3206 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3207 *recog_data.dup_loc[i]
3208 = *recog_data.operand_loc[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3209
3210 /* If any eliminable remain, they aren't eliminable anymore. */
3211 check_eliminable_occurrences (old_body);
3212
3213 /* Substitute the operands; the new values are in the substed_operand
3214 array. */
3215 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3216 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = substed_operand[i];
3217 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3218 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = substed_operand[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3219
3220 /* If we are replacing a body that was a (set X (plus Y Z)), try to
3221 re-recognize the insn. We do this in case we had a simple addition
3222 but now can do this as a load-address. This saves an insn in this
3223 common case.
3224 If re-recognition fails, the old insn code number will still be used,
3225 and some register operands may have changed into PLUS expressions.
3226 These will be handled by find_reloads by loading them into a register
3227 again. */
3228
3229 if (val)
3230 {
3231 /* If we aren't replacing things permanently and we changed something,
3232 make another copy to ensure that all the RTL is new. Otherwise
3233 things can go wrong if find_reload swaps commutative operands
3234 and one is inside RTL that has been copied while the other is not. */
3235 new_body = old_body;
3236 if (! replace)
3237 {
3238 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3239 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3240 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3241 }
3242 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3243
3244 /* If we had a move insn but now we don't, rerecognize it. This will
3245 cause spurious re-recognition if the old move had a PARALLEL since
3246 the new one still will, but we can't call single_set without
3247 having put NEW_BODY into the insn and the re-recognition won't
3248 hurt in this rare case. */
3249 /* ??? Why this huge if statement - why don't we just rerecognize the
3250 thing always? */
3251 if (! insn_is_asm
3252 && old_set != 0
3253 && ((REG_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3254 && (GET_CODE (new_body) != SET
3255 || !REG_P (SET_SRC (new_body))))
3256 /* If this was a load from or store to memory, compare
3257 the MEM in recog_data.operand to the one in the insn.
3258 If they are not equal, then rerecognize the insn. */
3259 || (old_set != 0
3260 && ((MEM_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3261 && SET_SRC (old_set) != recog_data.operand[1])
3262 || (MEM_P (SET_DEST (old_set))
3263 && SET_DEST (old_set) != recog_data.operand[0])))
3264 /* If this was an add insn before, rerecognize. */
3265 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS))
3266 {
3267 int new_icode = recog (PATTERN (insn), insn, 0);
3268 if (new_icode >= 0)
3269 INSN_CODE (insn) = new_icode;
3270 }
3271 }
3272
3273 /* Restore the old body. If there were any changes to it, we made a copy
3274 of it while the changes were still in place, so we'll correctly return
3275 a modified insn below. */
3276 if (! replace)
3277 {
3278 /* Restore the old body. */
3279 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3280 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = orig_operand[i];
3281 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3282 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = orig_operand[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3283 }
3284
3285 /* Update all elimination pairs to reflect the status after the current
3286 insn. The changes we make were determined by the earlier call to
3287 elimination_effects.
3288
3289 We also detect cases where register elimination cannot be done,
3290 namely, if a register would be both changed and referenced outside a MEM
3291 in the resulting insn since such an insn is often undefined and, even if
3292 not, we cannot know what meaning will be given to it. Note that it is
3293 valid to have a register used in an address in an insn that changes it
3294 (presumably with a pre- or post-increment or decrement).
3295
3296 If anything changes, return nonzero. */
3297
3298 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3299 {
3300 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset && ep->ref_outside_mem)
3301 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3302
3303 ep->ref_outside_mem = 0;
3304
3305 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset)
3306 val = 1;
3307 }
3308
3309 done:
3310 /* If we changed something, perform elimination in REG_NOTES. This is
3311 needed even when REPLACE is zero because a REG_DEAD note might refer
3312 to a register that we eliminate and could cause a different number
3313 of spill registers to be needed in the final reload pass than in
3314 the pre-passes. */
3315 if (val && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0)
3316 REG_NOTES (insn)
3317 = eliminate_regs_1 (REG_NOTES (insn), 0, REG_NOTES (insn), true);
3318
3319 return val;
3320 }
3321
3322 /* Loop through all elimination pairs.
3323 Recalculate the number not at initial offset.
3324
3325 Compute the maximum offset (minimum offset if the stack does not
3326 grow downward) for each elimination pair. */
3327
3328 static void
update_eliminable_offsets(void)3329 update_eliminable_offsets (void)
3330 {
3331 struct elim_table *ep;
3332
3333 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3334 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3335 {
3336 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset;
3337 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->offset != ep->initial_offset)
3338 num_not_at_initial_offset++;
3339 }
3340 }
3341
3342 /* Given X, a SET or CLOBBER of DEST, if DEST is the target of a register
3343 replacement we currently believe is valid, mark it as not eliminable if X
3344 modifies DEST in any way other than by adding a constant integer to it.
3345
3346 If DEST is the frame pointer, we do nothing because we assume that
3347 all assignments to the hard frame pointer are nonlocal gotos and are being
3348 done at a time when they are valid and do not disturb anything else.
3349 Some machines want to eliminate a fake argument pointer with either the
3350 frame or stack pointer. Assignments to the hard frame pointer must not
3351 prevent this elimination.
3352
3353 Called via note_stores from reload before starting its passes to scan
3354 the insns of the function. */
3355
3356 static void
mark_not_eliminable(rtx dest,rtx x,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3357 mark_not_eliminable (rtx dest, rtx x, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3358 {
3359 unsigned int i;
3360
3361 /* A SUBREG of a hard register here is just changing its mode. We should
3362 not see a SUBREG of an eliminable hard register, but check just in
3363 case. */
3364 if (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG)
3365 dest = SUBREG_REG (dest);
3366
3367 if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
3368 return;
3369
3370 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
3371 if (reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate && dest == reg_eliminate[i].to_rtx
3372 && (GET_CODE (x) != SET
3373 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) != PLUS
3374 || XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0) != dest
3375 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1)) != CONST_INT))
3376 {
3377 reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate_previous
3378 = reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;
3379 num_eliminable--;
3380 }
3381 }
3382
3383 /* Verify that the initial elimination offsets did not change since the
3384 last call to set_initial_elim_offsets. This is used to catch cases
3385 where something illegal happened during reload_as_needed that could
3386 cause incorrect code to be generated if we did not check for it. */
3387
3388 static bool
verify_initial_elim_offsets(void)3389 verify_initial_elim_offsets (void)
3390 {
3391 HOST_WIDE_INT t;
3392
3393 if (!num_eliminable)
3394 return true;
3395
3396 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3397 {
3398 struct elim_table *ep;
3399
3400 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3401 {
3402 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep->from, ep->to, t);
3403 if (t != ep->initial_offset)
3404 return false;
3405 }
3406 }
3407 #else
3408 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (t);
3409 if (t != reg_eliminate[0].initial_offset)
3410 return false;
3411 #endif
3412
3413 return true;
3414 }
3415
3416 /* Reset all offsets on eliminable registers to their initial values. */
3417
3418 static void
set_initial_elim_offsets(void)3419 set_initial_elim_offsets (void)
3420 {
3421 struct elim_table *ep = reg_eliminate;
3422
3423 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3424 for (; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3425 {
3426 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep->from, ep->to, ep->initial_offset);
3427 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset = ep->initial_offset;
3428 }
3429 #else
3430 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (ep->initial_offset);
3431 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset = ep->initial_offset;
3432 #endif
3433
3434 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3435 }
3436
3437 /* Subroutine of set_initial_label_offsets called via for_each_eh_label. */
3438
3439 static void
set_initial_eh_label_offset(rtx label)3440 set_initial_eh_label_offset (rtx label)
3441 {
3442 set_label_offsets (label, NULL_RTX, 1);
3443 }
3444
3445 /* Initialize the known label offsets.
3446 Set a known offset for each forced label to be at the initial offset
3447 of each elimination. We do this because we assume that all
3448 computed jumps occur from a location where each elimination is
3449 at its initial offset.
3450 For all other labels, show that we don't know the offsets. */
3451
3452 static void
set_initial_label_offsets(void)3453 set_initial_label_offsets (void)
3454 {
3455 rtx x;
3456 memset (offsets_known_at, 0, num_labels);
3457
3458 for (x = forced_labels; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
3459 if (XEXP (x, 0))
3460 set_label_offsets (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, 1);
3461
3462 for_each_eh_label (set_initial_eh_label_offset);
3463 }
3464
3465 /* Set all elimination offsets to the known values for the code label given
3466 by INSN. */
3467
3468 static void
set_offsets_for_label(rtx insn)3469 set_offsets_for_label (rtx insn)
3470 {
3471 unsigned int i;
3472 int label_nr = CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn);
3473 struct elim_table *ep;
3474
3475 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3476 for (i = 0, ep = reg_eliminate; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; ep++, i++)
3477 {
3478 ep->offset = ep->previous_offset
3479 = offsets_at[label_nr - first_label_num][i];
3480 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->offset != ep->initial_offset)
3481 num_not_at_initial_offset++;
3482 }
3483 }
3484
3485 /* See if anything that happened changes which eliminations are valid.
3486 For example, on the SPARC, whether or not the frame pointer can
3487 be eliminated can depend on what registers have been used. We need
3488 not check some conditions again (such as flag_omit_frame_pointer)
3489 since they can't have changed. */
3490
3491 static void
update_eliminables(HARD_REG_SET * pset)3492 update_eliminables (HARD_REG_SET *pset)
3493 {
3494 int previous_frame_pointer_needed = frame_pointer_needed;
3495 struct elim_table *ep;
3496
3497 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3498 if ((ep->from == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED)
3499 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3500 || ! CAN_ELIMINATE (ep->from, ep->to)
3501 #endif
3502 )
3503 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3504
3505 /* Look for the case where we have discovered that we can't replace
3506 register A with register B and that means that we will now be
3507 trying to replace register A with register C. This means we can
3508 no longer replace register C with register B and we need to disable
3509 such an elimination, if it exists. This occurs often with A == ap,
3510 B == sp, and C == fp. */
3511
3512 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3513 {
3514 struct elim_table *op;
3515 int new_to = -1;
3516
3517 if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
3518 {
3519 /* Find the current elimination for ep->from, if there is a
3520 new one. */
3521 for (op = reg_eliminate;
3522 op < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
3523 if (op->from == ep->from && op->can_eliminate)
3524 {
3525 new_to = op->to;
3526 break;
3527 }
3528
3529 /* See if there is an elimination of NEW_TO -> EP->TO. If so,
3530 disable it. */
3531 for (op = reg_eliminate;
3532 op < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
3533 if (op->from == new_to && op->to == ep->to)
3534 op->can_eliminate = 0;
3535 }
3536 }
3537
3538 /* See if any registers that we thought we could eliminate the previous
3539 time are no longer eliminable. If so, something has changed and we
3540 must spill the register. Also, recompute the number of eliminable
3541 registers and see if the frame pointer is needed; it is if there is
3542 no elimination of the frame pointer that we can perform. */
3543
3544 frame_pointer_needed = 1;
3545 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3546 {
3547 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3548 && ep->to != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
3549 frame_pointer_needed = 0;
3550
3551 if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
3552 {
3553 ep->can_eliminate_previous = 0;
3554 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset, ep->from);
3555 num_eliminable--;
3556 }
3557 }
3558
3559 /* If we didn't need a frame pointer last time, but we do now, spill
3560 the hard frame pointer. */
3561 if (frame_pointer_needed && ! previous_frame_pointer_needed)
3562 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
3563 }
3564
3565 /* Initialize the table of registers to eliminate. */
3566
3567 static void
init_elim_table(void)3568 init_elim_table (void)
3569 {
3570 struct elim_table *ep;
3571 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3572 const struct elim_table_1 *ep1;
3573 #endif
3574
3575 if (!reg_eliminate)
3576 reg_eliminate = xcalloc (sizeof (struct elim_table), NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS);
3577
3578 /* Does this function require a frame pointer? */
3579
3580 frame_pointer_needed = (! flag_omit_frame_pointer
3581 /* ?? If EXIT_IGNORE_STACK is set, we will not save
3582 and restore sp for alloca. So we can't eliminate
3583 the frame pointer in that case. At some point,
3584 we should improve this by emitting the
3585 sp-adjusting insns for this case. */
3586 || (current_function_calls_alloca
3587 && EXIT_IGNORE_STACK)
3588 || current_function_accesses_prior_frames
3589 || FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED);
3590
3591 num_eliminable = 0;
3592
3593 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3594 for (ep = reg_eliminate, ep1 = reg_eliminate_1;
3595 ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++, ep1++)
3596 {
3597 ep->from = ep1->from;
3598 ep->to = ep1->to;
3599 ep->can_eliminate = ep->can_eliminate_previous
3600 = (CAN_ELIMINATE (ep->from, ep->to)
3601 && ! (ep->to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && frame_pointer_needed));
3602 }
3603 #else
3604 reg_eliminate[0].from = reg_eliminate_1[0].from;
3605 reg_eliminate[0].to = reg_eliminate_1[0].to;
3606 reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate = reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate_previous
3607 = ! frame_pointer_needed;
3608 #endif
3609
3610 /* Count the number of eliminable registers and build the FROM and TO
3611 REG rtx's. Note that code in gen_rtx_REG will cause, e.g.,
3612 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM) to equal stack_pointer_rtx.
3613 We depend on this. */
3614 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < ®_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3615 {
3616 num_eliminable += ep->can_eliminate;
3617 ep->from_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->from);
3618 ep->to_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->to);
3619 }
3620 }
3621
3622 /* Kick all pseudos out of hard register REGNO.
3623
3624 If CANT_ELIMINATE is nonzero, it means that we are doing this spill
3625 because we found we can't eliminate some register. In the case, no pseudos
3626 are allowed to be in the register, even if they are only in a block that
3627 doesn't require spill registers, unlike the case when we are spilling this
3628 hard reg to produce another spill register.
3629
3630 Return nonzero if any pseudos needed to be kicked out. */
3631
3632 static void
spill_hard_reg(unsigned int regno,int cant_eliminate)3633 spill_hard_reg (unsigned int regno, int cant_eliminate)
3634 {
3635 int i;
3636
3637 if (cant_eliminate)
3638 {
3639 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs_global, regno);
3640 regs_ever_live[regno] = 1;
3641 }
3642
3643 /* Spill every pseudo reg that was allocated to this reg
3644 or to something that overlaps this reg. */
3645
3646 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
3647 if (reg_renumber[i] >= 0
3648 && (unsigned int) reg_renumber[i] <= regno
3649 && ((unsigned int) reg_renumber[i]
3650 + hard_regno_nregs[(unsigned int) reg_renumber[i]]
3651 [PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (i)]
3652 > regno))
3653 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
3654 }
3655
3656 /* After find_reload_regs has been run for all insn that need reloads,
3657 and/or spill_hard_regs was called, this function is used to actually
3658 spill pseudo registers and try to reallocate them. It also sets up the
3659 spill_regs array for use by choose_reload_regs. */
3660
3661 static int
finish_spills(int global)3662 finish_spills (int global)
3663 {
3664 struct insn_chain *chain;
3665 int something_changed = 0;
3666 unsigned i;
3667 reg_set_iterator rsi;
3668
3669 /* Build the spill_regs array for the function. */
3670 /* If there are some registers still to eliminate and one of the spill regs
3671 wasn't ever used before, additional stack space may have to be
3672 allocated to store this register. Thus, we may have changed the offset
3673 between the stack and frame pointers, so mark that something has changed.
3674
3675 One might think that we need only set VAL to 1 if this is a call-used
3676 register. However, the set of registers that must be saved by the
3677 prologue is not identical to the call-used set. For example, the
3678 register used by the call insn for the return PC is a call-used register,
3679 but must be saved by the prologue. */
3680
3681 n_spills = 0;
3682 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
3683 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs, i))
3684 {
3685 spill_reg_order[i] = n_spills;
3686 spill_regs[n_spills++] = i;
3687 if (num_eliminable && ! regs_ever_live[i])
3688 something_changed = 1;
3689 regs_ever_live[i] = 1;
3690 }
3691 else
3692 spill_reg_order[i] = -1;
3693
3694 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
3695 {
3696 /* Record the current hard register the pseudo is allocated to in
3697 pseudo_previous_regs so we avoid reallocating it to the same
3698 hard reg in a later pass. */
3699 gcc_assert (reg_renumber[i] >= 0);
3700
3701 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (pseudo_previous_regs[i], reg_renumber[i]);
3702 /* Mark it as no longer having a hard register home. */
3703 reg_renumber[i] = -1;
3704 /* We will need to scan everything again. */
3705 something_changed = 1;
3706 }
3707
3708 /* Retry global register allocation if possible. */
3709 if (global)
3710 {
3711 memset (pseudo_forbidden_regs, 0, max_regno * sizeof (HARD_REG_SET));
3712 /* For every insn that needs reloads, set the registers used as spill
3713 regs in pseudo_forbidden_regs for every pseudo live across the
3714 insn. */
3715 for (chain = insns_need_reload; chain; chain = chain->next_need_reload)
3716 {
3717 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
3718 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
3719 {
3720 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (pseudo_forbidden_regs[i],
3721 chain->used_spill_regs);
3722 }
3723 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
3724 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
3725 {
3726 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (pseudo_forbidden_regs[i],
3727 chain->used_spill_regs);
3728 }
3729 }
3730
3731 /* Retry allocating the spilled pseudos. For each reg, merge the
3732 various reg sets that indicate which hard regs can't be used,
3733 and call retry_global_alloc.
3734 We change spill_pseudos here to only contain pseudos that did not
3735 get a new hard register. */
3736 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < (unsigned)max_regno; i++)
3737 if (reg_old_renumber[i] != reg_renumber[i])
3738 {
3739 HARD_REG_SET forbidden;
3740 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden, bad_spill_regs_global);
3741 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden, pseudo_forbidden_regs[i]);
3742 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden, pseudo_previous_regs[i]);
3743 retry_global_alloc (i, forbidden);
3744 if (reg_renumber[i] >= 0)
3745 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
3746 }
3747 }
3748
3749 /* Fix up the register information in the insn chain.
3750 This involves deleting those of the spilled pseudos which did not get
3751 a new hard register home from the live_{before,after} sets. */
3752 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain; chain = chain->next)
3753 {
3754 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos;
3755 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2;
3756
3757 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain->live_throughout, &spilled_pseudos);
3758 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain->dead_or_set, &spilled_pseudos);
3759
3760 /* Mark any unallocated hard regs as available for spills. That
3761 makes inheritance work somewhat better. */
3762 if (chain->need_reload)
3763 {
3764 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
3765 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, &chain->dead_or_set);
3766 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, used_by_pseudos2);
3767
3768 /* Save the old value for the sanity test below. */
3769 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, chain->used_spill_regs);
3770
3771 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
3772 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos, &chain->dead_or_set);
3773 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos);
3774 AND_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs);
3775
3776 /* Make sure we only enlarge the set. */
3777 GO_IF_HARD_REG_SUBSET (used_by_pseudos2, chain->used_spill_regs, ok);
3778 gcc_unreachable ();
3779 ok:;
3780 }
3781 }
3782
3783 /* Let alter_reg modify the reg rtx's for the modified pseudos. */
3784 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < (unsigned)max_regno; i++)
3785 {
3786 int regno = reg_renumber[i];
3787 if (reg_old_renumber[i] == regno)
3788 continue;
3789
3790 alter_reg (i, reg_old_renumber[i]);
3791 reg_old_renumber[i] = regno;
3792 if (dump_file)
3793 {
3794 if (regno == -1)
3795 fprintf (dump_file, " Register %d now on stack.\n\n", i);
3796 else
3797 fprintf (dump_file, " Register %d now in %d.\n\n",
3798 i, reg_renumber[i]);
3799 }
3800 }
3801
3802 return something_changed;
3803 }
3804
3805 /* Find all paradoxical subregs within X and update reg_max_ref_width. */
3806
3807 static void
scan_paradoxical_subregs(rtx x)3808 scan_paradoxical_subregs (rtx x)
3809 {
3810 int i;
3811 const char *fmt;
3812 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
3813
3814 switch (code)
3815 {
3816 case REG:
3817 case CONST_INT:
3818 case CONST:
3819 case SYMBOL_REF:
3820 case LABEL_REF:
3821 case CONST_DOUBLE:
3822 case CONST_VECTOR: /* shouldn't happen, but just in case. */
3823 case CC0:
3824 case PC:
3825 case USE:
3826 case CLOBBER:
3827 return;
3828
3829 case SUBREG:
3830 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
3831 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
3832 > reg_max_ref_width[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))]))
3833 reg_max_ref_width[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))]
3834 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
3835 return;
3836
3837 default:
3838 break;
3839 }
3840
3841 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
3842 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3843 {
3844 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
3845 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XEXP (x, i));
3846 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
3847 {
3848 int j;
3849 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
3850 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
3851 }
3852 }
3853 }
3854
3855 /* A subroutine of reload_as_needed. If INSN has a REG_EH_REGION note,
3856 examine all of the reload insns between PREV and NEXT exclusive, and
3857 annotate all that may trap. */
3858
3859 static void
fixup_eh_region_note(rtx insn,rtx prev,rtx next)3860 fixup_eh_region_note (rtx insn, rtx prev, rtx next)
3861 {
3862 rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL_RTX);
3863 unsigned int trap_count;
3864 rtx i;
3865
3866 if (note == NULL)
3867 return;
3868
3869 if (may_trap_p (PATTERN (insn)))
3870 trap_count = 1;
3871 else
3872 {
3873 remove_note (insn, note);
3874 trap_count = 0;
3875 }
3876
3877 for (i = NEXT_INSN (prev); i != next; i = NEXT_INSN (i))
3878 if (INSN_P (i) && i != insn && may_trap_p (PATTERN (i)))
3879 {
3880 trap_count++;
3881 REG_NOTES (i)
3882 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EH_REGION, XEXP (note, 0), REG_NOTES (i));
3883 }
3884 }
3885
3886 /* Reload pseudo-registers into hard regs around each insn as needed.
3887 Additional register load insns are output before the insn that needs it
3888 and perhaps store insns after insns that modify the reloaded pseudo reg.
3889
3890 reg_last_reload_reg and reg_reloaded_contents keep track of
3891 which registers are already available in reload registers.
3892 We update these for the reloads that we perform,
3893 as the insns are scanned. */
3894
3895 static void
reload_as_needed(int live_known)3896 reload_as_needed (int live_known)
3897 {
3898 struct insn_chain *chain;
3899 #if defined (AUTO_INC_DEC)
3900 int i;
3901 #endif
3902 rtx x;
3903
3904 memset (spill_reg_rtx, 0, sizeof spill_reg_rtx);
3905 memset (spill_reg_store, 0, sizeof spill_reg_store);
3906 reg_last_reload_reg = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
3907 INIT_REG_SET (®_has_output_reload);
3908 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);
3909 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered);
3910
3911 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
3912
3913 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain; chain = chain->next)
3914 {
3915 rtx prev = 0;
3916 rtx insn = chain->insn;
3917 rtx old_next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
3918
3919 /* If we pass a label, copy the offsets from the label information
3920 into the current offsets of each elimination. */
3921 if (LABEL_P (insn))
3922 set_offsets_for_label (insn);
3923
3924 else if (INSN_P (insn))
3925 {
3926 regset_head regs_to_forget;
3927 INIT_REG_SET (®s_to_forget);
3928 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), forget_old_reloads_1, ®s_to_forget);
3929
3930 /* If this is a USE and CLOBBER of a MEM, ensure that any
3931 references to eliminable registers have been removed. */
3932
3933 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
3934 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER)
3935 && MEM_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)))
3936 XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)
3937 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0),
3938 GET_MODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)),
3939 NULL_RTX);
3940
3941 /* If we need to do register elimination processing, do so.
3942 This might delete the insn, in which case we are done. */
3943 if ((num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants) && chain->need_elim)
3944 {
3945 eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 1);
3946 if (NOTE_P (insn))
3947 {
3948 update_eliminable_offsets ();
3949 CLEAR_REG_SET (®s_to_forget);
3950 continue;
3951 }
3952 }
3953
3954 /* If need_elim is nonzero but need_reload is zero, one might think
3955 that we could simply set n_reloads to 0. However, find_reloads
3956 could have done some manipulation of the insn (such as swapping
3957 commutative operands), and these manipulations are lost during
3958 the first pass for every insn that needs register elimination.
3959 So the actions of find_reloads must be redone here. */
3960
3961 if (! chain->need_elim && ! chain->need_reload
3962 && ! chain->need_operand_change)
3963 n_reloads = 0;
3964 /* First find the pseudo regs that must be reloaded for this insn.
3965 This info is returned in the tables reload_... (see reload.h).
3966 Also modify the body of INSN by substituting RELOAD
3967 rtx's for those pseudo regs. */
3968 else
3969 {
3970 CLEAR_REG_SET (®_has_output_reload);
3971 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_is_output_reload);
3972
3973 find_reloads (insn, 1, spill_indirect_levels, live_known,
3974 spill_reg_order);
3975 }
3976
3977 if (n_reloads > 0)
3978 {
3979 rtx next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
3980 rtx p;
3981
3982 prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
3983
3984 /* Now compute which reload regs to reload them into. Perhaps
3985 reusing reload regs from previous insns, or else output
3986 load insns to reload them. Maybe output store insns too.
3987 Record the choices of reload reg in reload_reg_rtx. */
3988 choose_reload_regs (chain);
3989
3990 /* Merge any reloads that we didn't combine for fear of
3991 increasing the number of spill registers needed but now
3992 discover can be safely merged. */
3993 if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES)
3994 merge_assigned_reloads (insn);
3995
3996 /* Generate the insns to reload operands into or out of
3997 their reload regs. */
3998 emit_reload_insns (chain);
3999
4000 /* Substitute the chosen reload regs from reload_reg_rtx
4001 into the insn's body (or perhaps into the bodies of other
4002 load and store insn that we just made for reloading
4003 and that we moved the structure into). */
4004 subst_reloads (insn);
4005
4006 /* Adjust the exception region notes for loads and stores. */
4007 if (flag_non_call_exceptions && !CALL_P (insn))
4008 fixup_eh_region_note (insn, prev, next);
4009
4010 /* If this was an ASM, make sure that all the reload insns
4011 we have generated are valid. If not, give an error
4012 and delete them. */
4013 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
4014 for (p = NEXT_INSN (prev); p != next; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
4015 if (p != insn && INSN_P (p)
4016 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (p)) != USE
4017 && (recog_memoized (p) < 0
4018 || (extract_insn (p), ! constrain_operands (1))))
4019 {
4020 error_for_asm (insn,
4021 "%<asm%> operand requires "
4022 "impossible reload");
4023 delete_insn (p);
4024 }
4025 }
4026
4027 if (num_eliminable && chain->need_elim)
4028 update_eliminable_offsets ();
4029
4030 /* Any previously reloaded spilled pseudo reg, stored in this insn,
4031 is no longer validly lying around to save a future reload.
4032 Note that this does not detect pseudos that were reloaded
4033 for this insn in order to be stored in
4034 (obeying register constraints). That is correct; such reload
4035 registers ARE still valid. */
4036 forget_marked_reloads (®s_to_forget);
4037 CLEAR_REG_SET (®s_to_forget);
4038
4039 /* There may have been CLOBBER insns placed after INSN. So scan
4040 between INSN and NEXT and use them to forget old reloads. */
4041 for (x = NEXT_INSN (insn); x != old_next; x = NEXT_INSN (x))
4042 if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (x) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (x)) == CLOBBER)
4043 note_stores (PATTERN (x), forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
4044
4045 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
4046 /* Likewise for regs altered by auto-increment in this insn.
4047 REG_INC notes have been changed by reloading:
4048 find_reloads_address_1 records substitutions for them,
4049 which have been performed by subst_reloads above. */
4050 for (i = n_reloads - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4051 {
4052 rtx in_reg = rld[i].in_reg;
4053 if (in_reg)
4054 {
4055 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (in_reg);
4056 /* PRE_INC / PRE_DEC will have the reload register ending up
4057 with the same value as the stack slot, but that doesn't
4058 hold true for POST_INC / POST_DEC. Either we have to
4059 convert the memory access to a true POST_INC / POST_DEC,
4060 or we can't use the reload register for inheritance. */
4061 if ((code == POST_INC || code == POST_DEC)
4062 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
4063 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx))
4064 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
4065 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
4066 && ((unsigned) reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx)]
4067 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))))
4068
4069 {
4070 rtx reload_reg = rld[i].reg_rtx;
4071 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (reload_reg);
4072 int n = 0;
4073 rtx p;
4074
4075 for (p = PREV_INSN (old_next); p != prev; p = PREV_INSN (p))
4076 {
4077 /* We really want to ignore REG_INC notes here, so
4078 use PATTERN (p) as argument to reg_set_p . */
4079 if (reg_set_p (reload_reg, PATTERN (p)))
4080 break;
4081 n = count_occurrences (PATTERN (p), reload_reg, 0);
4082 if (! n)
4083 continue;
4084 if (n == 1)
4085 {
4086 n = validate_replace_rtx (reload_reg,
4087 gen_rtx_fmt_e (code,
4088 mode,
4089 reload_reg),
4090 p);
4091
4092 /* We must also verify that the constraints
4093 are met after the replacement. */
4094 extract_insn (p);
4095 if (n)
4096 n = constrain_operands (1);
4097 else
4098 break;
4099
4100 /* If the constraints were not met, then
4101 undo the replacement. */
4102 if (!n)
4103 {
4104 validate_replace_rtx (gen_rtx_fmt_e (code,
4105 mode,
4106 reload_reg),
4107 reload_reg, p);
4108 break;
4109 }
4110
4111 }
4112 break;
4113 }
4114 if (n == 1)
4115 {
4116 REG_NOTES (p)
4117 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_INC, reload_reg,
4118 REG_NOTES (p));
4119 /* Mark this as having an output reload so that the
4120 REG_INC processing code below won't invalidate
4121 the reload for inheritance. */
4122 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
4123 REGNO (reload_reg));
4124 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (®_has_output_reload,
4125 REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0)));
4126 }
4127 else
4128 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (in_reg, 0), NULL_RTX,
4129 NULL);
4130 }
4131 else if ((code == PRE_INC || code == PRE_DEC)
4132 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
4133 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx))
4134 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
4135 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
4136 && ((unsigned) reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx)]
4137 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))))
4138 {
4139 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
4140 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx));
4141 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (®_has_output_reload,
4142 REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0)));
4143 }
4144 }
4145 }
4146 /* If a pseudo that got a hard register is auto-incremented,
4147 we must purge records of copying it into pseudos without
4148 hard registers. */
4149 for (x = REG_NOTES (insn); x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
4150 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_INC)
4151 {
4152 /* See if this pseudo reg was reloaded in this insn.
4153 If so, its last-reload info is still valid
4154 because it is based on this insn's reload. */
4155 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
4156 if (rld[i].out == XEXP (x, 0))
4157 break;
4158
4159 if (i == n_reloads)
4160 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, NULL);
4161 }
4162 #endif
4163 }
4164 /* A reload reg's contents are unknown after a label. */
4165 if (LABEL_P (insn))
4166 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);
4167
4168 /* Don't assume a reload reg is still good after a call insn
4169 if it is a call-used reg, or if it contains a value that will
4170 be partially clobbered by the call. */
4171 else if (CALL_P (insn))
4172 {
4173 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid, call_used_reg_set);
4174 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid, reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered);
4175 }
4176 }
4177
4178 /* Clean up. */
4179 free (reg_last_reload_reg);
4180 CLEAR_REG_SET (®_has_output_reload);
4181 }
4182
4183 /* Discard all record of any value reloaded from X,
4184 or reloaded in X from someplace else;
4185 unless X is an output reload reg of the current insn.
4186
4187 X may be a hard reg (the reload reg)
4188 or it may be a pseudo reg that was reloaded from.
4189
4190 When DATA is non-NULL just mark the registers in regset
4191 to be forgotten later. */
4192
4193 static void
forget_old_reloads_1(rtx x,rtx ignored ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,void * data)4194 forget_old_reloads_1 (rtx x, rtx ignored ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4195 void *data)
4196 {
4197 unsigned int regno;
4198 unsigned int nr;
4199 regset regs = (regset) data;
4200
4201 /* note_stores does give us subregs of hard regs,
4202 subreg_regno_offset requires a hard reg. */
4203 while (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
4204 {
4205 /* We ignore the subreg offset when calculating the regno,
4206 because we are using the entire underlying hard register
4207 below. */
4208 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
4209 }
4210
4211 if (!REG_P (x))
4212 return;
4213
4214 regno = REGNO (x);
4215
4216 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4217 nr = 1;
4218 else
4219 {
4220 unsigned int i;
4221
4222 nr = hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (x)];
4223 /* Storing into a spilled-reg invalidates its contents.
4224 This can happen if a block-local pseudo is allocated to that reg
4225 and it wasn't spilled because this block's total need is 0.
4226 Then some insn might have an optional reload and use this reg. */
4227 if (!regs)
4228 for (i = 0; i < nr; i++)
4229 /* But don't do this if the reg actually serves as an output
4230 reload reg in the current instruction. */
4231 if (n_reloads == 0
4232 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, regno + i))
4233 {
4234 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno + i);
4235 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered, regno + i);
4236 spill_reg_store[regno + i] = 0;
4237 }
4238 }
4239
4240 if (regs)
4241 while (nr-- > 0)
4242 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (regs, regno + nr);
4243 else
4244 {
4245 /* Since value of X has changed,
4246 forget any value previously copied from it. */
4247
4248 while (nr-- > 0)
4249 /* But don't forget a copy if this is the output reload
4250 that establishes the copy's validity. */
4251 if (n_reloads == 0
4252 || !REGNO_REG_SET_P (®_has_output_reload, regno + nr))
4253 reg_last_reload_reg[regno + nr] = 0;
4254 }
4255 }
4256
4257 /* Forget the reloads marked in regset by previous function. */
4258 static void
forget_marked_reloads(regset regs)4259 forget_marked_reloads (regset regs)
4260 {
4261 unsigned int reg;
4262 reg_set_iterator rsi;
4263 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (regs, 0, reg, rsi)
4264 {
4265 if (reg < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4266 /* But don't do this if the reg actually serves as an output
4267 reload reg in the current instruction. */
4268 && (n_reloads == 0
4269 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, reg)))
4270 {
4271 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, reg);
4272 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered, reg);
4273 spill_reg_store[reg] = 0;
4274 }
4275 if (n_reloads == 0
4276 || !REGNO_REG_SET_P (®_has_output_reload, reg))
4277 reg_last_reload_reg[reg] = 0;
4278 }
4279 }
4280
4281 /* The following HARD_REG_SETs indicate when each hard register is
4282 used for a reload of various parts of the current insn. */
4283
4284 /* If reg is unavailable for all reloads. */
4285 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_unavailable;
4286 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for a RELOAD_OTHER reload. */
4287 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used;
4288 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4289 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4290 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4291 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4292 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4293 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4294 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4295 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4296 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for operand I. */
4297 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4298 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload for operand I. */
4299 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4300 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reload. */
4301 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
4302 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reload. */
4303 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
4304 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INSN reload. */
4305 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_insn;
4306 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reload. */
4307 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;
4308
4309 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for any sort of reload. */
4310 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_at_all;
4311
4312 /* If reg is use as an inherited reload. We just mark the first register
4313 in the group. */
4314 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_for_inherit;
4315
4316 /* Records which hard regs are used in any way, either as explicit use or
4317 by being allocated to a pseudo during any point of the current insn. */
4318 static HARD_REG_SET reg_used_in_insn;
4319
4320 /* Mark reg REGNO as in use for a reload of the sort spec'd by OPNUM and
4321 TYPE. MODE is used to indicate how many consecutive regs are
4322 actually used. */
4323
4324 static void
mark_reload_reg_in_use(unsigned int regno,int opnum,enum reload_type type,enum machine_mode mode)4325 mark_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int regno, int opnum, enum reload_type type,
4326 enum machine_mode mode)
4327 {
4328 unsigned int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
4329 unsigned int i;
4330
4331 for (i = regno; i < nregs + regno; i++)
4332 {
4333 switch (type)
4334 {
4335 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4336 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, i);
4337 break;
4338
4339 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4340 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], i);
4341 break;
4342
4343 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4344 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], i);
4345 break;
4346
4347 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4348 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], i);
4349 break;
4350
4351 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4352 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], i);
4353 break;
4354
4355 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4356 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, i);
4357 break;
4358
4359 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4360 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, i);
4361 break;
4362
4363 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4364 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, i);
4365 break;
4366
4367 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4368 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum], i);
4369 break;
4370
4371 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4372 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum], i);
4373 break;
4374
4375 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4376 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, i);
4377 break;
4378 }
4379
4380 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all, i);
4381 }
4382 }
4383
4384 /* Similarly, but show REGNO is no longer in use for a reload. */
4385
4386 static void
clear_reload_reg_in_use(unsigned int regno,int opnum,enum reload_type type,enum machine_mode mode)4387 clear_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int regno, int opnum,
4388 enum reload_type type, enum machine_mode mode)
4389 {
4390 unsigned int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
4391 unsigned int start_regno, end_regno, r;
4392 int i;
4393 /* A complication is that for some reload types, inheritance might
4394 allow multiple reloads of the same types to share a reload register.
4395 We set check_opnum if we have to check only reloads with the same
4396 operand number, and check_any if we have to check all reloads. */
4397 int check_opnum = 0;
4398 int check_any = 0;
4399 HARD_REG_SET *used_in_set;
4400
4401 switch (type)
4402 {
4403 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4404 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used;
4405 break;
4406
4407 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4408 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum];
4409 break;
4410
4411 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4412 check_opnum = 1;
4413 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum];
4414 break;
4415
4416 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4417 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum];
4418 break;
4419
4420 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4421 check_opnum = 1;
4422 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum];
4423 break;
4424
4425 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4426 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
4427 break;
4428
4429 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4430 check_any = 1;
4431 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
4432 break;
4433
4434 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4435 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;
4436 check_any = 1;
4437 break;
4438
4439 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4440 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum];
4441 break;
4442
4443 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4444 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum];
4445 break;
4446
4447 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4448 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_insn;
4449 break;
4450 default:
4451 gcc_unreachable ();
4452 }
4453 /* We resolve conflicts with remaining reloads of the same type by
4454 excluding the intervals of reload registers by them from the
4455 interval of freed reload registers. Since we only keep track of
4456 one set of interval bounds, we might have to exclude somewhat
4457 more than what would be necessary if we used a HARD_REG_SET here.
4458 But this should only happen very infrequently, so there should
4459 be no reason to worry about it. */
4460
4461 start_regno = regno;
4462 end_regno = regno + nregs;
4463 if (check_opnum || check_any)
4464 {
4465 for (i = n_reloads - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4466 {
4467 if (rld[i].when_needed == type
4468 && (check_any || rld[i].opnum == opnum)
4469 && rld[i].reg_rtx)
4470 {
4471 unsigned int conflict_start = true_regnum (rld[i].reg_rtx);
4472 unsigned int conflict_end
4473 = (conflict_start
4474 + hard_regno_nregs[conflict_start][rld[i].mode]);
4475
4476 /* If there is an overlap with the first to-be-freed register,
4477 adjust the interval start. */
4478 if (conflict_start <= start_regno && conflict_end > start_regno)
4479 start_regno = conflict_end;
4480 /* Otherwise, if there is a conflict with one of the other
4481 to-be-freed registers, adjust the interval end. */
4482 if (conflict_start > start_regno && conflict_start < end_regno)
4483 end_regno = conflict_start;
4484 }
4485 }
4486 }
4487
4488 for (r = start_regno; r < end_regno; r++)
4489 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*used_in_set, r);
4490 }
4491
4492 /* 1 if reg REGNO is free as a reload reg for a reload of the sort
4493 specified by OPNUM and TYPE. */
4494
4495 static int
reload_reg_free_p(unsigned int regno,int opnum,enum reload_type type)4496 reload_reg_free_p (unsigned int regno, int opnum, enum reload_type type)
4497 {
4498 int i;
4499
4500 /* In use for a RELOAD_OTHER means it's not available for anything. */
4501 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno)
4502 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, regno))
4503 return 0;
4504
4505 switch (type)
4506 {
4507 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4508 /* In use for anything means we can't use it for RELOAD_OTHER. */
4509 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno)
4510 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4511 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno)
4512 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
4513 return 0;
4514
4515 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4516 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4517 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
4518 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4519 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4520 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
4521 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4522 return 0;
4523
4524 return 1;
4525
4526 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4527 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4528 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno))
4529 return 0;
4530
4531 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
4532 return 0;
4533
4534 /* If it is used for some other input, can't use it. */
4535 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4536 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4537 return 0;
4538
4539 /* If it is used in a later operand's address, can't use it. */
4540 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4541 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4542 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
4543 return 0;
4544
4545 return 1;
4546
4547 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4548 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address for this
4549 operand or used as an input in an earlier one. */
4550 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], regno)
4551 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
4552 return 0;
4553
4554 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
4555 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4556 return 0;
4557
4558 return 1;
4559
4560 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4561 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address
4562 for this operand or used as an input in an earlier
4563 one. */
4564 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
4565 return 0;
4566
4567 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
4568 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4569 return 0;
4570
4571 return 1;
4572
4573 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4574 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address for this
4575 operand or used as an output in this or a later operand. Note
4576 that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order, so
4577 the conflicting ones are those with lower indices. */
4578 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], regno))
4579 return 0;
4580
4581 for (i = 0; i <= opnum; i++)
4582 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4583 return 0;
4584
4585 return 1;
4586
4587 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4588 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address
4589 for this operand or used as an output in this or a
4590 later operand. Note that multiple output operands are
4591 emitted in reverse order, so the conflicting ones are
4592 those with lower indices. */
4593 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
4594 return 0;
4595
4596 for (i = 0; i <= opnum; i++)
4597 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4598 return 0;
4599
4600 return 1;
4601
4602 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4603 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4604 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4605 return 0;
4606
4607 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4608 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));
4609
4610 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4611 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4612 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4613 return 0;
4614
4615 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno));
4616
4617 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4618 /* This cannot share a register with RELOAD_FOR_INSN reloads, other
4619 outputs, or an operand address for this or an earlier output.
4620 Note that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order,
4621 so the conflicting ones are those with higher indices. */
4622 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
4623 return 0;
4624
4625 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4626 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4627 return 0;
4628
4629 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4630 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4631 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
4632 return 0;
4633
4634 return 1;
4635
4636 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4637 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4638 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
4639 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4640 return 0;
4641
4642 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4643 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));
4644
4645 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4646 return ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno);
4647
4648 default:
4649 gcc_unreachable ();
4650 }
4651 }
4652
4653 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
4654 needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
4655 is still available in REGNO at the end of the insn.
4656
4657 We can assume that the reload reg was already tested for availability
4658 at the time it is needed, and we should not check this again,
4659 in case the reg has already been marked in use. */
4660
4661 static int
reload_reg_reaches_end_p(unsigned int regno,int opnum,enum reload_type type)4662 reload_reg_reaches_end_p (unsigned int regno, int opnum, enum reload_type type)
4663 {
4664 int i;
4665
4666 switch (type)
4667 {
4668 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4669 /* Since a RELOAD_OTHER reload claims the reg for the entire insn,
4670 its value must reach the end. */
4671 return 1;
4672
4673 /* If this use is for part of the insn,
4674 its value reaches if no subsequent part uses the same register.
4675 Just like the above function, don't try to do this with lots
4676 of fallthroughs. */
4677
4678 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4679 /* Here we check for everything else, since these don't conflict
4680 with anything else and everything comes later. */
4681
4682 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4683 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4684 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4685 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno)
4686 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4687 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
4688 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4689 return 0;
4690
4691 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4692 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno)
4693 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4694 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
4695
4696 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4697 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4698 /* Similar, except that we check only for this and subsequent inputs
4699 and the address of only subsequent inputs and we do not need
4700 to check for RELOAD_OTHER objects since they are known not to
4701 conflict. */
4702
4703 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4704 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4705 return 0;
4706
4707 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4708 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4709 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
4710 return 0;
4711
4712 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4713 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4714 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4715 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4716 return 0;
4717
4718 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
4719 return 0;
4720
4721 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4722 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4723 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
4724
4725 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4726 /* Similar to input address, except we start at the next operand for
4727 both input and input address and we do not check for
4728 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INSN since these
4729 would conflict. */
4730
4731 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4732 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4733 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
4734 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4735 return 0;
4736
4737 /* ... fall through ... */
4738
4739 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4740 /* Check outputs and their addresses. */
4741
4742 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4743 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4744 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4745 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4746 return 0;
4747
4748 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
4749
4750 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4751 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4752 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4753 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4754 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4755 return 0;
4756
4757 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4758 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4759 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
4760
4761 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4762 /* These conflict with other outputs with RELOAD_OTHER. So
4763 we need only check for output addresses. */
4764
4765 opnum = reload_n_operands;
4766
4767 /* ... fall through ... */
4768
4769 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4770 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4771 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4772 /* We already know these can't conflict with a later output. So the
4773 only thing to check are later output addresses.
4774 Note that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order,
4775 so the conflicting ones are those with lower indices. */
4776 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
4777 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4778 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
4779 return 0;
4780
4781 return 1;
4782
4783 default:
4784 gcc_unreachable ();
4785 }
4786 }
4787
4788 /* Return 1 if the reloads denoted by R1 and R2 cannot share a register.
4789 Return 0 otherwise.
4790
4791 This function uses the same algorithm as reload_reg_free_p above. */
4792
4793 static int
reloads_conflict(int r1,int r2)4794 reloads_conflict (int r1, int r2)
4795 {
4796 enum reload_type r1_type = rld[r1].when_needed;
4797 enum reload_type r2_type = rld[r2].when_needed;
4798 int r1_opnum = rld[r1].opnum;
4799 int r2_opnum = rld[r2].opnum;
4800
4801 /* RELOAD_OTHER conflicts with everything. */
4802 if (r2_type == RELOAD_OTHER)
4803 return 1;
4804
4805 /* Otherwise, check conflicts differently for each type. */
4806
4807 switch (r1_type)
4808 {
4809 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4810 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
4811 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
4812 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
4813 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
4814 || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
4815 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
4816 && r2_opnum > r1_opnum));
4817
4818 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4819 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
4820 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));
4821
4822 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4823 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
4824 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));
4825
4826 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4827 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
4828 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum <= r1_opnum));
4829
4830 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4831 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
4832 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum <= r1_opnum));
4833
4834 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4835 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
4836 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS);
4837
4838 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4839 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
4840 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR);
4841
4842 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4843 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
4844 || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
4845 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS)
4846 && r2_opnum >= r1_opnum));
4847
4848 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4849 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
4850 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
4851 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS);
4852
4853 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4854 return r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS;
4855
4856 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4857 return 1;
4858
4859 default:
4860 gcc_unreachable ();
4861 }
4862 }
4863
4864 /* Indexed by reload number, 1 if incoming value
4865 inherited from previous insns. */
4866 static char reload_inherited[MAX_RELOADS];
4867
4868 /* For an inherited reload, this is the insn the reload was inherited from,
4869 if we know it. Otherwise, this is 0. */
4870 static rtx reload_inheritance_insn[MAX_RELOADS];
4871
4872 /* If nonzero, this is a place to get the value of the reload,
4873 rather than using reload_in. */
4874 static rtx reload_override_in[MAX_RELOADS];
4875
4876 /* For each reload, the hard register number of the register used,
4877 or -1 if we did not need a register for this reload. */
4878 static int reload_spill_index[MAX_RELOADS];
4879
4880 /* Subroutine of free_for_value_p, used to check a single register.
4881 START_REGNO is the starting regno of the full reload register
4882 (possibly comprising multiple hard registers) that we are considering. */
4883
4884 static int
reload_reg_free_for_value_p(int start_regno,int regno,int opnum,enum reload_type type,rtx value,rtx out,int reloadnum,int ignore_address_reloads)4885 reload_reg_free_for_value_p (int start_regno, int regno, int opnum,
4886 enum reload_type type, rtx value, rtx out,
4887 int reloadnum, int ignore_address_reloads)
4888 {
4889 int time1;
4890 /* Set if we see an input reload that must not share its reload register
4891 with any new earlyclobber, but might otherwise share the reload
4892 register with an output or input-output reload. */
4893 int check_earlyclobber = 0;
4894 int i;
4895 int copy = 0;
4896
4897 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, regno))
4898 return 0;
4899
4900 if (out == const0_rtx)
4901 {
4902 copy = 1;
4903 out = NULL_RTX;
4904 }
4905
4906 /* We use some pseudo 'time' value to check if the lifetimes of the
4907 new register use would overlap with the one of a previous reload
4908 that is not read-only or uses a different value.
4909 The 'time' used doesn't have to be linear in any shape or form, just
4910 monotonic.
4911 Some reload types use different 'buckets' for each operand.
4912 So there are MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS different time values for each
4913 such reload type.
4914 We compute TIME1 as the time when the register for the prospective
4915 new reload ceases to be live, and TIME2 for each existing
4916 reload as the time when that the reload register of that reload
4917 becomes live.
4918 Where there is little to be gained by exact lifetime calculations,
4919 we just make conservative assumptions, i.e. a longer lifetime;
4920 this is done in the 'default:' cases. */
4921 switch (type)
4922 {
4923 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4924 /* RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS conflicts with RELOAD_OTHER reloads. */
4925 time1 = copy ? 0 : 1;
4926 break;
4927 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4928 time1 = copy ? 1 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 5 + 5;
4929 break;
4930 /* For each input, we may have a sequence of RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS,
4931 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INPUT. By adding 0 / 1 / 2 ,
4932 respectively, to the time values for these, we get distinct time
4933 values. To get distinct time values for each operand, we have to
4934 multiply opnum by at least three. We round that up to four because
4935 multiply by four is often cheaper. */
4936 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4937 time1 = opnum * 4 + 2;
4938 break;
4939 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4940 time1 = opnum * 4 + 3;
4941 break;
4942 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4943 /* All RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reloads remain live till the instruction
4944 executes (inclusive). */
4945 time1 = copy ? opnum * 4 + 4 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
4946 break;
4947 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4948 /* opnum * 4 + 4
4949 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS - 1) * 4 + 4 == MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 */
4950 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 1;
4951 break;
4952 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4953 /* RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads are live even while the insn
4954 is executed. */
4955 time1 = copy ? MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 2 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
4956 break;
4957 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4958 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4 + opnum;
4959 break;
4960 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4961 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 5 + opnum;
4962 break;
4963 default:
4964 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 5 + 5;
4965 }
4966
4967 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
4968 {
4969 rtx reg = rld[i].reg_rtx;
4970 if (reg && REG_P (reg)
4971 && ((unsigned) regno - true_regnum (reg)
4972 <= hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (reg)][GET_MODE (reg)] - (unsigned) 1)
4973 && i != reloadnum)
4974 {
4975 rtx other_input = rld[i].in;
4976
4977 /* If the other reload loads the same input value, that
4978 will not cause a conflict only if it's loading it into
4979 the same register. */
4980 if (true_regnum (reg) != start_regno)
4981 other_input = NULL_RTX;
4982 if (! other_input || ! rtx_equal_p (other_input, value)
4983 || rld[i].out || out)
4984 {
4985 int time2;
4986 switch (rld[i].when_needed)
4987 {
4988 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4989 time2 = 0;
4990 break;
4991 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4992 /* find_reloads makes sure that a
4993 RELOAD_FOR_{INP,OP,OUT}ADDR_ADDRESS reload is only used
4994 by at most one - the first -
4995 RELOAD_FOR_{INPUT,OPERAND,OUTPUT}_ADDRESS . If the
4996 address reload is inherited, the address address reload
4997 goes away, so we can ignore this conflict. */
4998 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
4999 && ignore_address_reloads
5000 /* Unless the RELOAD_FOR_INPUT is an auto_inc expression.
5001 Then the address address is still needed to store
5002 back the new address. */
5003 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5004 continue;
5005 /* Likewise, if a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT can inherit a value, its
5006 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
5007 reloads go away. */
5008 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && opnum == rld[i].opnum
5009 && ignore_address_reloads
5010 /* Unless we are reloading an auto_inc expression. */
5011 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5012 continue;
5013 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 2;
5014 break;
5015 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5016 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && opnum == rld[i].opnum
5017 && ignore_address_reloads
5018 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5019 continue;
5020 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 3;
5021 break;
5022 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5023 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 4;
5024 check_earlyclobber = 1;
5025 break;
5026 /* rld[i].opnum * 4 + 4 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERAND - 1) * 4 + 4
5027 == MAX_RECOG_OPERAND * 4 */
5028 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5029 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
5030 && ignore_address_reloads
5031 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5032 continue;
5033 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 1;
5034 break;
5035 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5036 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 2;
5037 check_earlyclobber = 1;
5038 break;
5039 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5040 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
5041 break;
5042 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5043 /* All RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads become live just after the
5044 instruction is executed. */
5045 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4;
5046 break;
5047 /* The first RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload conflicts with
5048 the RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads, so assign it the same time
5049 value. */
5050 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5051 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
5052 && ignore_address_reloads
5053 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5054 continue;
5055 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4 + rld[i].opnum;
5056 break;
5057 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5058 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 5 + rld[i].opnum;
5059 break;
5060 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5061 /* If there is no conflict in the input part, handle this
5062 like an output reload. */
5063 if (! rld[i].in || rtx_equal_p (other_input, value))
5064 {
5065 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4;
5066 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
5067 if (earlyclobber_operand_p (rld[i].out))
5068 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
5069
5070 break;
5071 }
5072 time2 = 1;
5073 /* RELOAD_OTHER might be live beyond instruction execution,
5074 but this is not obvious when we set time2 = 1. So check
5075 here if there might be a problem with the new reload
5076 clobbering the register used by the RELOAD_OTHER. */
5077 if (out)
5078 return 0;
5079 break;
5080 default:
5081 return 0;
5082 }
5083 if ((time1 >= time2
5084 && (! rld[i].in || rld[i].out
5085 || ! rtx_equal_p (other_input, value)))
5086 || (out && rld[reloadnum].out_reg
5087 && time2 >= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3))
5088 return 0;
5089 }
5090 }
5091 }
5092
5093 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
5094 if (check_earlyclobber && out && earlyclobber_operand_p (out))
5095 return 0;
5096
5097 return 1;
5098 }
5099
5100 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
5101 needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
5102 may be used to load VALUE into it.
5103
5104 MODE is the mode in which the register is used, this is needed to
5105 determine how many hard regs to test.
5106
5107 Other read-only reloads with the same value do not conflict
5108 unless OUT is nonzero and these other reloads have to live while
5109 output reloads live.
5110 If OUT is CONST0_RTX, this is a special case: it means that the
5111 test should not be for using register REGNO as reload register, but
5112 for copying from register REGNO into the reload register.
5113
5114 RELOADNUM is the number of the reload we want to load this value for;
5115 a reload does not conflict with itself.
5116
5117 When IGNORE_ADDRESS_RELOADS is set, we can not have conflicts with
5118 reloads that load an address for the very reload we are considering.
5119
5120 The caller has to make sure that there is no conflict with the return
5121 register. */
5122
5123 static int
free_for_value_p(int regno,enum machine_mode mode,int opnum,enum reload_type type,rtx value,rtx out,int reloadnum,int ignore_address_reloads)5124 free_for_value_p (int regno, enum machine_mode mode, int opnum,
5125 enum reload_type type, rtx value, rtx out, int reloadnum,
5126 int ignore_address_reloads)
5127 {
5128 int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
5129 while (nregs-- > 0)
5130 if (! reload_reg_free_for_value_p (regno, regno + nregs, opnum, type,
5131 value, out, reloadnum,
5132 ignore_address_reloads))
5133 return 0;
5134 return 1;
5135 }
5136
5137 /* Return nonzero if the rtx X is invariant over the current function. */
5138 /* ??? Actually, the places where we use this expect exactly what is
5139 tested here, and not everything that is function invariant. In
5140 particular, the frame pointer and arg pointer are special cased;
5141 pic_offset_table_rtx is not, and we must not spill these things to
5142 memory. */
5143
5144 int
function_invariant_p(rtx x)5145 function_invariant_p (rtx x)
5146 {
5147 if (CONSTANT_P (x))
5148 return 1;
5149 if (x == frame_pointer_rtx || x == arg_pointer_rtx)
5150 return 1;
5151 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
5152 && (XEXP (x, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx || XEXP (x, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx)
5153 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
5154 return 1;
5155 return 0;
5156 }
5157
5158 /* Determine whether the reload reg X overlaps any rtx'es used for
5159 overriding inheritance. Return nonzero if so. */
5160
5161 static int
conflicts_with_override(rtx x)5162 conflicts_with_override (rtx x)
5163 {
5164 int i;
5165 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5166 if (reload_override_in[i]
5167 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, reload_override_in[i]))
5168 return 1;
5169 return 0;
5170 }
5171
5172 /* Give an error message saying we failed to find a reload for INSN,
5173 and clear out reload R. */
5174 static void
failed_reload(rtx insn,int r)5175 failed_reload (rtx insn, int r)
5176 {
5177 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
5178 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
5179 fatal_insn ("could not find a spill register", insn);
5180
5181 /* It's the user's fault; the operand's mode and constraint
5182 don't match. Disable this reload so we don't crash in final. */
5183 error_for_asm (insn,
5184 "%<asm%> operand constraint incompatible with operand size");
5185 rld[r].in = 0;
5186 rld[r].out = 0;
5187 rld[r].reg_rtx = 0;
5188 rld[r].optional = 1;
5189 rld[r].secondary_p = 1;
5190 }
5191
5192 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to allocate
5193 for reload R. If it's valid, get an rtx for it. Return nonzero if
5194 successful. */
5195 static int
set_reload_reg(int i,int r)5196 set_reload_reg (int i, int r)
5197 {
5198 int regno;
5199 rtx reg = spill_reg_rtx[i];
5200
5201 if (reg == 0 || GET_MODE (reg) != rld[r].mode)
5202 spill_reg_rtx[i] = reg
5203 = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r].mode, spill_regs[i]);
5204
5205 regno = true_regnum (reg);
5206
5207 /* Detect when the reload reg can't hold the reload mode.
5208 This used to be one `if', but Sequent compiler can't handle that. */
5209 if (HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rld[r].mode))
5210 {
5211 enum machine_mode test_mode = VOIDmode;
5212 if (rld[r].in)
5213 test_mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in);
5214 /* If rld[r].in has VOIDmode, it means we will load it
5215 in whatever mode the reload reg has: to wit, rld[r].mode.
5216 We have already tested that for validity. */
5217 /* Aside from that, we need to test that the expressions
5218 to reload from or into have modes which are valid for this
5219 reload register. Otherwise the reload insns would be invalid. */
5220 if (! (rld[r].in != 0 && test_mode != VOIDmode
5221 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, test_mode)))
5222 if (! (rld[r].out != 0
5223 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, GET_MODE (rld[r].out))))
5224 {
5225 /* The reg is OK. */
5226 last_spill_reg = i;
5227
5228 /* Mark as in use for this insn the reload regs we use
5229 for this. */
5230 mark_reload_reg_in_use (spill_regs[i], rld[r].opnum,
5231 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].mode);
5232
5233 rld[r].reg_rtx = reg;
5234 reload_spill_index[r] = spill_regs[i];
5235 return 1;
5236 }
5237 }
5238 return 0;
5239 }
5240
5241 /* Find a spill register to use as a reload register for reload R.
5242 LAST_RELOAD is nonzero if this is the last reload for the insn being
5243 processed.
5244
5245 Set rld[R].reg_rtx to the register allocated.
5246
5247 We return 1 if successful, or 0 if we couldn't find a spill reg and
5248 we didn't change anything. */
5249
5250 static int
allocate_reload_reg(struct insn_chain * chain ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,int r,int last_reload)5251 allocate_reload_reg (struct insn_chain *chain ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int r,
5252 int last_reload)
5253 {
5254 int i, pass, count;
5255
5256 /* If we put this reload ahead, thinking it is a group,
5257 then insist on finding a group. Otherwise we can grab a
5258 reg that some other reload needs.
5259 (That can happen when we have a 68000 DATA_OR_FP_REG
5260 which is a group of data regs or one fp reg.)
5261 We need not be so restrictive if there are no more reloads
5262 for this insn.
5263
5264 ??? Really it would be nicer to have smarter handling
5265 for that kind of reg class, where a problem like this is normal.
5266 Perhaps those classes should be avoided for reloading
5267 by use of more alternatives. */
5268
5269 int force_group = rld[r].nregs > 1 && ! last_reload;
5270
5271 /* If we want a single register and haven't yet found one,
5272 take any reg in the right class and not in use.
5273 If we want a consecutive group, here is where we look for it.
5274
5275 We use two passes so we can first look for reload regs to
5276 reuse, which are already in use for other reloads in this insn,
5277 and only then use additional registers.
5278 I think that maximizing reuse is needed to make sure we don't
5279 run out of reload regs. Suppose we have three reloads, and
5280 reloads A and B can share regs. These need two regs.
5281 Suppose A and B are given different regs.
5282 That leaves none for C. */
5283 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; pass++)
5284 {
5285 /* I is the index in spill_regs.
5286 We advance it round-robin between insns to use all spill regs
5287 equally, so that inherited reloads have a chance
5288 of leapfrogging each other. */
5289
5290 i = last_spill_reg;
5291
5292 for (count = 0; count < n_spills; count++)
5293 {
5294 int class = (int) rld[r].class;
5295 int regnum;
5296
5297 i++;
5298 if (i >= n_spills)
5299 i -= n_spills;
5300 regnum = spill_regs[i];
5301
5302 if ((reload_reg_free_p (regnum, rld[r].opnum,
5303 rld[r].when_needed)
5304 || (rld[r].in
5305 /* We check reload_reg_used to make sure we
5306 don't clobber the return register. */
5307 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regnum)
5308 && free_for_value_p (regnum, rld[r].mode, rld[r].opnum,
5309 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
5310 rld[r].out, r, 1)))
5311 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], regnum)
5312 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regnum, rld[r].mode)
5313 /* Look first for regs to share, then for unshared. But
5314 don't share regs used for inherited reloads; they are
5315 the ones we want to preserve. */
5316 && (pass
5317 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all,
5318 regnum)
5319 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
5320 regnum))))
5321 {
5322 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[regnum][rld[r].mode];
5323 /* Avoid the problem where spilling a GENERAL_OR_FP_REG
5324 (on 68000) got us two FP regs. If NR is 1,
5325 we would reject both of them. */
5326 if (force_group)
5327 nr = rld[r].nregs;
5328 /* If we need only one reg, we have already won. */
5329 if (nr == 1)
5330 {
5331 /* But reject a single reg if we demand a group. */
5332 if (force_group)
5333 continue;
5334 break;
5335 }
5336 /* Otherwise check that as many consecutive regs as we need
5337 are available here. */
5338 while (nr > 1)
5339 {
5340 int regno = regnum + nr - 1;
5341 if (!(TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], regno)
5342 && spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0
5343 && reload_reg_free_p (regno, rld[r].opnum,
5344 rld[r].when_needed)))
5345 break;
5346 nr--;
5347 }
5348 if (nr == 1)
5349 break;
5350 }
5351 }
5352
5353 /* If we found something on pass 1, omit pass 2. */
5354 if (count < n_spills)
5355 break;
5356 }
5357
5358 /* We should have found a spill register by now. */
5359 if (count >= n_spills)
5360 return 0;
5361
5362 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to
5363 allocate. Get an rtx for it and find its register number. */
5364
5365 return set_reload_reg (i, r);
5366 }
5367
5368 /* Initialize all the tables needed to allocate reload registers.
5369 CHAIN is the insn currently being processed; SAVE_RELOAD_REG_RTX
5370 is the array we use to restore the reg_rtx field for every reload. */
5371
5372 static void
choose_reload_regs_init(struct insn_chain * chain,rtx * save_reload_reg_rtx)5373 choose_reload_regs_init (struct insn_chain *chain, rtx *save_reload_reg_rtx)
5374 {
5375 int i;
5376
5377 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5378 rld[i].reg_rtx = save_reload_reg_rtx[i];
5379
5380 memset (reload_inherited, 0, MAX_RELOADS);
5381 memset (reload_inheritance_insn, 0, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));
5382 memset (reload_override_in, 0, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));
5383
5384 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used);
5385 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_at_all);
5386 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr);
5387 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload);
5388 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_insn);
5389 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr);
5390
5391 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn);
5392 {
5393 HARD_REG_SET tmp;
5394 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp, &chain->live_throughout);
5395 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn, tmp);
5396 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp, &chain->dead_or_set);
5397 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn, tmp);
5398 compute_use_by_pseudos (®_used_in_insn, &chain->live_throughout);
5399 compute_use_by_pseudos (®_used_in_insn, &chain->dead_or_set);
5400 }
5401
5402 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5403 {
5404 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output[i]);
5405 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input[i]);
5406 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i]);
5407 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i]);
5408 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i]);
5409 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i]);
5410 }
5411
5412 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_unavailable, chain->used_spill_regs);
5413
5414 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_for_inherit);
5415
5416 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5417 /* If we have already decided to use a certain register,
5418 don't use it in another way. */
5419 if (rld[i].reg_rtx)
5420 mark_reload_reg_in_use (REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx), rld[i].opnum,
5421 rld[i].when_needed, rld[i].mode);
5422 }
5423
5424 /* Assign hard reg targets for the pseudo-registers we must reload
5425 into hard regs for this insn.
5426 Also output the instructions to copy them in and out of the hard regs.
5427
5428 For machines with register classes, we are responsible for
5429 finding a reload reg in the proper class. */
5430
5431 static void
choose_reload_regs(struct insn_chain * chain)5432 choose_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *chain)
5433 {
5434 rtx insn = chain->insn;
5435 int i, j;
5436 unsigned int max_group_size = 1;
5437 enum reg_class group_class = NO_REGS;
5438 int pass, win, inheritance;
5439
5440 rtx save_reload_reg_rtx[MAX_RELOADS];
5441
5442 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
5443 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
5444 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
5445 that provided the reload registers.
5446
5447 Also note whether any of the reloads wants a consecutive group of regs.
5448 If so, record the maximum size of the group desired and what
5449 register class contains all the groups needed by this insn. */
5450
5451 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5452 {
5453 reload_order[j] = j;
5454 if (rld[j].reg_rtx != NULL_RTX)
5455 {
5456 gcc_assert (REG_P (rld[j].reg_rtx)
5457 && HARD_REGISTER_P (rld[j].reg_rtx));
5458 reload_spill_index[j] = REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx);
5459 }
5460 else
5461 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
5462
5463 if (rld[j].nregs > 1)
5464 {
5465 max_group_size = MAX (rld[j].nregs, max_group_size);
5466 group_class
5467 = reg_class_superunion[(int) rld[j].class][(int) group_class];
5468 }
5469
5470 save_reload_reg_rtx[j] = rld[j].reg_rtx;
5471 }
5472
5473 if (n_reloads > 1)
5474 qsort (reload_order, n_reloads, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower);
5475
5476 /* If -O, try first with inheritance, then turning it off.
5477 If not -O, don't do inheritance.
5478 Using inheritance when not optimizing leads to paradoxes
5479 with fp on the 68k: fp numbers (not NaNs) fail to be equal to themselves
5480 because one side of the comparison might be inherited. */
5481 win = 0;
5482 for (inheritance = optimize > 0; inheritance >= 0; inheritance--)
5483 {
5484 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx);
5485
5486 /* Process the reloads in order of preference just found.
5487 Beyond this point, subregs can be found in reload_reg_rtx.
5488
5489 This used to look for an existing reloaded home for all of the
5490 reloads, and only then perform any new reloads. But that could lose
5491 if the reloads were done out of reg-class order because a later
5492 reload with a looser constraint might have an old home in a register
5493 needed by an earlier reload with a tighter constraint.
5494
5495 To solve this, we make two passes over the reloads, in the order
5496 described above. In the first pass we try to inherit a reload
5497 from a previous insn. If there is a later reload that needs a
5498 class that is a proper subset of the class being processed, we must
5499 also allocate a spill register during the first pass.
5500
5501 Then make a second pass over the reloads to allocate any reloads
5502 that haven't been given registers yet. */
5503
5504 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5505 {
5506 int r = reload_order[j];
5507 rtx search_equiv = NULL_RTX;
5508
5509 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
5510 if (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].in == 0
5511 && ! rld[r].secondary_p)
5512 continue;
5513
5514 /* If find_reloads chose to use reload_in or reload_out as a reload
5515 register, we don't need to chose one. Otherwise, try even if it
5516 found one since we might save an insn if we find the value lying
5517 around.
5518 Try also when reload_in is a pseudo without a hard reg. */
5519 if (rld[r].in != 0 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0
5520 && (rtx_equal_p (rld[r].in, rld[r].reg_rtx)
5521 || (rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, rld[r].reg_rtx)
5522 && !MEM_P (rld[r].in)
5523 && true_regnum (rld[r].in) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
5524 continue;
5525
5526 #if 0 /* No longer needed for correct operation.
5527 It might give better code, or might not; worth an experiment? */
5528 /* If this is an optional reload, we can't inherit from earlier insns
5529 until we are sure that any non-optional reloads have been allocated.
5530 The following code takes advantage of the fact that optional reloads
5531 are at the end of reload_order. */
5532 if (rld[r].optional != 0)
5533 for (i = 0; i < j; i++)
5534 if ((rld[reload_order[i]].out != 0
5535 || rld[reload_order[i]].in != 0
5536 || rld[reload_order[i]].secondary_p)
5537 && ! rld[reload_order[i]].optional
5538 && rld[reload_order[i]].reg_rtx == 0)
5539 allocate_reload_reg (chain, reload_order[i], 0);
5540 #endif
5541
5542 /* First see if this pseudo is already available as reloaded
5543 for a previous insn. We cannot try to inherit for reloads
5544 that are smaller than the maximum number of registers needed
5545 for groups unless the register we would allocate cannot be used
5546 for the groups.
5547
5548 We could check here to see if this is a secondary reload for
5549 an object that is already in a register of the desired class.
5550 This would avoid the need for the secondary reload register.
5551 But this is complex because we can't easily determine what
5552 objects might want to be loaded via this reload. So let a
5553 register be allocated here. In `emit_reload_insns' we suppress
5554 one of the loads in the case described above. */
5555
5556 if (inheritance)
5557 {
5558 int byte = 0;
5559 int regno = -1;
5560 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
5561
5562 if (rld[r].in == 0)
5563 ;
5564 else if (REG_P (rld[r].in))
5565 {
5566 regno = REGNO (rld[r].in);
5567 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in);
5568 }
5569 else if (REG_P (rld[r].in_reg))
5570 {
5571 regno = REGNO (rld[r].in_reg);
5572 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in_reg);
5573 }
5574 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == SUBREG
5575 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in_reg)))
5576 {
5577 byte = SUBREG_BYTE (rld[r].in_reg);
5578 regno = REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in_reg));
5579 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5580 regno = subreg_regno (rld[r].in_reg);
5581 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in_reg);
5582 }
5583 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
5584 else if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg)) == RTX_AUTOINC
5585 && REG_P (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0)))
5586 {
5587 regno = REGNO (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
5588 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
5589 rld[r].out = rld[r].in;
5590 }
5591 #endif
5592 #if 0
5593 /* This won't work, since REGNO can be a pseudo reg number.
5594 Also, it takes much more hair to keep track of all the things
5595 that can invalidate an inherited reload of part of a pseudoreg. */
5596 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == SUBREG
5597 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in)))
5598 regno = subreg_regno (rld[r].in);
5599 #endif
5600
5601 if (regno >= 0 && reg_last_reload_reg[regno] != 0)
5602 {
5603 enum reg_class class = rld[r].class, last_class;
5604 rtx last_reg = reg_last_reload_reg[regno];
5605 enum machine_mode need_mode;
5606
5607 i = REGNO (last_reg);
5608 i += subreg_regno_offset (i, GET_MODE (last_reg), byte, mode);
5609 last_class = REGNO_REG_CLASS (i);
5610
5611 if (byte == 0)
5612 need_mode = mode;
5613 else
5614 need_mode
5615 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)
5616 + byte * BITS_PER_UNIT,
5617 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode));
5618
5619 if ((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (last_reg))
5620 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (need_mode))
5621 #ifdef CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS
5622 /* Verify that the register in "i" can be obtained
5623 from LAST_REG. */
5624 && !REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (REGNO (last_reg),
5625 GET_MODE (last_reg),
5626 mode)
5627 #endif
5628 && reg_reloaded_contents[i] == regno
5629 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i)
5630 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (i, rld[r].mode)
5631 && (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) class], i)
5632 /* Even if we can't use this register as a reload
5633 register, we might use it for reload_override_in,
5634 if copying it to the desired class is cheap
5635 enough. */
5636 || ((REGISTER_MOVE_COST (mode, last_class, class)
5637 < MEMORY_MOVE_COST (mode, class, 1))
5638 && (secondary_reload_class (1, class, mode,
5639 last_reg)
5640 == NO_REGS)
5641 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
5642 && ! SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (last_class, class,
5643 mode)
5644 #endif
5645 ))
5646
5647 && (rld[r].nregs == max_group_size
5648 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) group_class],
5649 i))
5650 && free_for_value_p (i, rld[r].mode, rld[r].opnum,
5651 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
5652 const0_rtx, r, 1))
5653 {
5654 /* If a group is needed, verify that all the subsequent
5655 registers still have their values intact. */
5656 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[i][rld[r].mode];
5657 int k;
5658
5659 for (k = 1; k < nr; k++)
5660 if (reg_reloaded_contents[i + k] != regno
5661 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k))
5662 break;
5663
5664 if (k == nr)
5665 {
5666 int i1;
5667 int bad_for_class;
5668
5669 last_reg = (GET_MODE (last_reg) == mode
5670 ? last_reg : gen_rtx_REG (mode, i));
5671
5672 bad_for_class = 0;
5673 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
5674 bad_for_class |= ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rld[r].class],
5675 i+k);
5676
5677 /* We found a register that contains the
5678 value we need. If this register is the
5679 same as an `earlyclobber' operand of the
5680 current insn, just mark it as a place to
5681 reload from since we can't use it as the
5682 reload register itself. */
5683
5684 for (i1 = 0; i1 < n_earlyclobbers; i1++)
5685 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p
5686 (reg_last_reload_reg[regno],
5687 reload_earlyclobbers[i1]))
5688 break;
5689
5690 if (i1 != n_earlyclobbers
5691 || ! (free_for_value_p (i, rld[r].mode,
5692 rld[r].opnum,
5693 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
5694 rld[r].out, r, 1))
5695 /* Don't use it if we'd clobber a pseudo reg. */
5696 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_used_in_insn, i)
5697 && rld[r].out
5698 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i))
5699 /* Don't clobber the frame pointer. */
5700 || (i == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
5701 && frame_pointer_needed
5702 && rld[r].out)
5703 /* Don't really use the inherited spill reg
5704 if we need it wider than we've got it. */
5705 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (rld[r].mode)
5706 > GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
5707 || bad_for_class
5708
5709 /* If find_reloads chose reload_out as reload
5710 register, stay with it - that leaves the
5711 inherited register for subsequent reloads. */
5712 || (rld[r].out && rld[r].reg_rtx
5713 && rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, rld[r].reg_rtx)))
5714 {
5715 if (! rld[r].optional)
5716 {
5717 reload_override_in[r] = last_reg;
5718 reload_inheritance_insn[r]
5719 = reg_reloaded_insn[i];
5720 }
5721 }
5722 else
5723 {
5724 int k;
5725 /* We can use this as a reload reg. */
5726 /* Mark the register as in use for this part of
5727 the insn. */
5728 mark_reload_reg_in_use (i,
5729 rld[r].opnum,
5730 rld[r].when_needed,
5731 rld[r].mode);
5732 rld[r].reg_rtx = last_reg;
5733 reload_inherited[r] = 1;
5734 reload_inheritance_insn[r]
5735 = reg_reloaded_insn[i];
5736 reload_spill_index[r] = i;
5737 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
5738 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
5739 i + k);
5740 }
5741 }
5742 }
5743 }
5744 }
5745
5746 /* Here's another way to see if the value is already lying around. */
5747 if (inheritance
5748 && rld[r].in != 0
5749 && ! reload_inherited[r]
5750 && rld[r].out == 0
5751 && (CONSTANT_P (rld[r].in)
5752 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == PLUS
5753 || REG_P (rld[r].in)
5754 || MEM_P (rld[r].in))
5755 && (rld[r].nregs == max_group_size
5756 || ! reg_classes_intersect_p (rld[r].class, group_class)))
5757 search_equiv = rld[r].in;
5758 /* If this is an output reload from a simple move insn, look
5759 if an equivalence for the input is available. */
5760 else if (inheritance && rld[r].in == 0 && rld[r].out != 0)
5761 {
5762 rtx set = single_set (insn);
5763
5764 if (set
5765 && rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, SET_DEST (set))
5766 && CONSTANT_P (SET_SRC (set)))
5767 search_equiv = SET_SRC (set);
5768 }
5769
5770 if (search_equiv)
5771 {
5772 rtx equiv
5773 = find_equiv_reg (search_equiv, insn, rld[r].class,
5774 -1, NULL, 0, rld[r].mode);
5775 int regno = 0;
5776
5777 if (equiv != 0)
5778 {
5779 if (REG_P (equiv))
5780 regno = REGNO (equiv);
5781 else
5782 {
5783 /* This must be a SUBREG of a hard register.
5784 Make a new REG since this might be used in an
5785 address and not all machines support SUBREGs
5786 there. */
5787 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (equiv) == SUBREG);
5788 regno = subreg_regno (equiv);
5789 equiv = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r].mode, regno);
5790 /* If we choose EQUIV as the reload register, but the
5791 loop below decides to cancel the inheritance, we'll
5792 end up reloading EQUIV in rld[r].mode, not the mode
5793 it had originally. That isn't safe when EQUIV isn't
5794 available as a spill register since its value might
5795 still be live at this point. */
5796 for (i = regno; i < regno + (int) rld[r].nregs; i++)
5797 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, i))
5798 equiv = 0;
5799 }
5800 }
5801
5802 /* If we found a spill reg, reject it unless it is free
5803 and of the desired class. */
5804 if (equiv != 0)
5805 {
5806 int regs_used = 0;
5807 int bad_for_class = 0;
5808 int max_regno = regno + rld[r].nregs;
5809
5810 for (i = regno; i < max_regno; i++)
5811 {
5812 regs_used |= TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all,
5813 i);
5814 bad_for_class |= ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rld[r].class],
5815 i);
5816 }
5817
5818 if ((regs_used
5819 && ! free_for_value_p (regno, rld[r].mode,
5820 rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed,
5821 rld[r].in, rld[r].out, r, 1))
5822 || bad_for_class)
5823 equiv = 0;
5824 }
5825
5826 if (equiv != 0 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rld[r].mode))
5827 equiv = 0;
5828
5829 /* We found a register that contains the value we need.
5830 If this register is the same as an `earlyclobber' operand
5831 of the current insn, just mark it as a place to reload from
5832 since we can't use it as the reload register itself. */
5833
5834 if (equiv != 0)
5835 for (i = 0; i < n_earlyclobbers; i++)
5836 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (equiv,
5837 reload_earlyclobbers[i]))
5838 {
5839 if (! rld[r].optional)
5840 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
5841 equiv = 0;
5842 break;
5843 }
5844
5845 /* If the equiv register we have found is explicitly clobbered
5846 in the current insn, it depends on the reload type if we
5847 can use it, use it for reload_override_in, or not at all.
5848 In particular, we then can't use EQUIV for a
5849 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload. */
5850
5851 if (equiv != 0)
5852 {
5853 if (regno_clobbered_p (regno, insn, rld[r].mode, 2))
5854 switch (rld[r].when_needed)
5855 {
5856 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5857 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5858 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5859 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5860 break;
5861 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5862 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5863 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5864 if (! rld[r].optional)
5865 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
5866 /* Fall through. */
5867 default:
5868 equiv = 0;
5869 break;
5870 }
5871 else if (regno_clobbered_p (regno, insn, rld[r].mode, 1))
5872 switch (rld[r].when_needed)
5873 {
5874 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5875 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5876 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5877 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5878 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5879 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5880 break;
5881 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5882 if (! rld[r].optional)
5883 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
5884 /* Fall through. */
5885 default:
5886 equiv = 0;
5887 break;
5888 }
5889 }
5890
5891 /* If we found an equivalent reg, say no code need be generated
5892 to load it, and use it as our reload reg. */
5893 if (equiv != 0
5894 && (regno != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
5895 || !frame_pointer_needed))
5896 {
5897 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[regno][rld[r].mode];
5898 int k;
5899 rld[r].reg_rtx = equiv;
5900 reload_inherited[r] = 1;
5901
5902 /* If reg_reloaded_valid is not set for this register,
5903 there might be a stale spill_reg_store lying around.
5904 We must clear it, since otherwise emit_reload_insns
5905 might delete the store. */
5906 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno))
5907 spill_reg_store[regno] = NULL_RTX;
5908 /* If any of the hard registers in EQUIV are spill
5909 registers, mark them as in use for this insn. */
5910 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
5911 {
5912 i = spill_reg_order[regno + k];
5913 if (i >= 0)
5914 {
5915 mark_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[r].opnum,
5916 rld[r].when_needed,
5917 rld[r].mode);
5918 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
5919 regno + k);
5920 }
5921 }
5922 }
5923 }
5924
5925 /* If we found a register to use already, or if this is an optional
5926 reload, we are done. */
5927 if (rld[r].reg_rtx != 0 || rld[r].optional != 0)
5928 continue;
5929
5930 #if 0
5931 /* No longer needed for correct operation. Might or might
5932 not give better code on the average. Want to experiment? */
5933
5934 /* See if there is a later reload that has a class different from our
5935 class that intersects our class or that requires less register
5936 than our reload. If so, we must allocate a register to this
5937 reload now, since that reload might inherit a previous reload
5938 and take the only available register in our class. Don't do this
5939 for optional reloads since they will force all previous reloads
5940 to be allocated. Also don't do this for reloads that have been
5941 turned off. */
5942
5943 for (i = j + 1; i < n_reloads; i++)
5944 {
5945 int s = reload_order[i];
5946
5947 if ((rld[s].in == 0 && rld[s].out == 0
5948 && ! rld[s].secondary_p)
5949 || rld[s].optional)
5950 continue;
5951
5952 if ((rld[s].class != rld[r].class
5953 && reg_classes_intersect_p (rld[r].class,
5954 rld[s].class))
5955 || rld[s].nregs < rld[r].nregs)
5956 break;
5957 }
5958
5959 if (i == n_reloads)
5960 continue;
5961
5962 allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, j == n_reloads - 1);
5963 #endif
5964 }
5965
5966 /* Now allocate reload registers for anything non-optional that
5967 didn't get one yet. */
5968 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5969 {
5970 int r = reload_order[j];
5971
5972 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
5973 if (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].in == 0 && ! rld[r].secondary_p)
5974 continue;
5975
5976 /* Skip reloads that already have a register allocated or are
5977 optional. */
5978 if (rld[r].reg_rtx != 0 || rld[r].optional)
5979 continue;
5980
5981 if (! allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, j == n_reloads - 1))
5982 break;
5983 }
5984
5985 /* If that loop got all the way, we have won. */
5986 if (j == n_reloads)
5987 {
5988 win = 1;
5989 break;
5990 }
5991
5992 /* Loop around and try without any inheritance. */
5993 }
5994
5995 if (! win)
5996 {
5997 /* First undo everything done by the failed attempt
5998 to allocate with inheritance. */
5999 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx);
6000
6001 /* Some sanity tests to verify that the reloads found in the first
6002 pass are identical to the ones we have now. */
6003 gcc_assert (chain->n_reloads == n_reloads);
6004
6005 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
6006 {
6007 if (chain->rld[i].regno < 0 || chain->rld[i].reg_rtx != 0)
6008 continue;
6009 gcc_assert (chain->rld[i].when_needed == rld[i].when_needed);
6010 for (j = 0; j < n_spills; j++)
6011 if (spill_regs[j] == chain->rld[i].regno)
6012 if (! set_reload_reg (j, i))
6013 failed_reload (chain->insn, i);
6014 }
6015 }
6016
6017 /* If we thought we could inherit a reload, because it seemed that
6018 nothing else wanted the same reload register earlier in the insn,
6019 verify that assumption, now that all reloads have been assigned.
6020 Likewise for reloads where reload_override_in has been set. */
6021
6022 /* If doing expensive optimizations, do one preliminary pass that doesn't
6023 cancel any inheritance, but removes reloads that have been needed only
6024 for reloads that we know can be inherited. */
6025 for (pass = flag_expensive_optimizations; pass >= 0; pass--)
6026 {
6027 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6028 {
6029 int r = reload_order[j];
6030 rtx check_reg;
6031 if (reload_inherited[r] && rld[r].reg_rtx)
6032 check_reg = rld[r].reg_rtx;
6033 else if (reload_override_in[r]
6034 && (REG_P (reload_override_in[r])
6035 || GET_CODE (reload_override_in[r]) == SUBREG))
6036 check_reg = reload_override_in[r];
6037 else
6038 continue;
6039 if (! free_for_value_p (true_regnum (check_reg), rld[r].mode,
6040 rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
6041 (reload_inherited[r]
6042 ? rld[r].out : const0_rtx),
6043 r, 1))
6044 {
6045 if (pass)
6046 continue;
6047 reload_inherited[r] = 0;
6048 reload_override_in[r] = 0;
6049 }
6050 /* If we can inherit a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT, or can use a
6051 reload_override_in, then we do not need its related
6052 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads;
6053 likewise for other reload types.
6054 We handle this by removing a reload when its only replacement
6055 is mentioned in reload_in of the reload we are going to inherit.
6056 A special case are auto_inc expressions; even if the input is
6057 inherited, we still need the address for the output. We can
6058 recognize them because they have RELOAD_OUT set to RELOAD_IN.
6059 If we succeeded removing some reload and we are doing a preliminary
6060 pass just to remove such reloads, make another pass, since the
6061 removal of one reload might allow us to inherit another one. */
6062 else if (rld[r].in
6063 && rld[r].out != rld[r].in
6064 && remove_address_replacements (rld[r].in) && pass)
6065 pass = 2;
6066 }
6067 }
6068
6069 /* Now that reload_override_in is known valid,
6070 actually override reload_in. */
6071 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6072 if (reload_override_in[j])
6073 rld[j].in = reload_override_in[j];
6074
6075 /* If this reload won't be done because it has been canceled or is
6076 optional and not inherited, clear reload_reg_rtx so other
6077 routines (such as subst_reloads) don't get confused. */
6078 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6079 if (rld[j].reg_rtx != 0
6080 && ((rld[j].optional && ! reload_inherited[j])
6081 || (rld[j].in == 0 && rld[j].out == 0
6082 && ! rld[j].secondary_p)))
6083 {
6084 int regno = true_regnum (rld[j].reg_rtx);
6085
6086 if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
6087 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[j].opnum,
6088 rld[j].when_needed, rld[j].mode);
6089 rld[j].reg_rtx = 0;
6090 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
6091 }
6092
6093 /* Record which pseudos and which spill regs have output reloads. */
6094 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6095 {
6096 int r = reload_order[j];
6097
6098 i = reload_spill_index[r];
6099
6100 /* I is nonneg if this reload uses a register.
6101 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
6102 that we opted to ignore. */
6103 if (rld[r].out_reg != 0 && REG_P (rld[r].out_reg)
6104 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0)
6105 {
6106 int nregno = REGNO (rld[r].out_reg);
6107 int nr = 1;
6108
6109 if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6110 nr = hard_regno_nregs[nregno][rld[r].mode];
6111
6112 while (--nr >= 0)
6113 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (®_has_output_reload,
6114 nregno + nr);
6115
6116 if (i >= 0)
6117 {
6118 nr = hard_regno_nregs[i][rld[r].mode];
6119 while (--nr >= 0)
6120 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, i + nr);
6121 }
6122
6123 gcc_assert (rld[r].when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER
6124 || rld[r].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
6125 || rld[r].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INSN);
6126 }
6127 }
6128 }
6129
6130 /* Deallocate the reload register for reload R. This is called from
6131 remove_address_replacements. */
6132
6133 void
deallocate_reload_reg(int r)6134 deallocate_reload_reg (int r)
6135 {
6136 int regno;
6137
6138 if (! rld[r].reg_rtx)
6139 return;
6140 regno = true_regnum (rld[r].reg_rtx);
6141 rld[r].reg_rtx = 0;
6142 if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
6143 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed,
6144 rld[r].mode);
6145 reload_spill_index[r] = -1;
6146 }
6147
6148 /* If SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES is nonzero, we may not have merged two
6149 reloads of the same item for fear that we might not have enough reload
6150 registers. However, normally they will get the same reload register
6151 and hence actually need not be loaded twice.
6152
6153 Here we check for the most common case of this phenomenon: when we have
6154 a number of reloads for the same object, each of which were allocated
6155 the same reload_reg_rtx, that reload_reg_rtx is not used for any other
6156 reload, and is not modified in the insn itself. If we find such,
6157 merge all the reloads and set the resulting reload to RELOAD_OTHER.
6158 This will not increase the number of spill registers needed and will
6159 prevent redundant code. */
6160
6161 static void
merge_assigned_reloads(rtx insn)6162 merge_assigned_reloads (rtx insn)
6163 {
6164 int i, j;
6165
6166 /* Scan all the reloads looking for ones that only load values and
6167 are not already RELOAD_OTHER and ones whose reload_reg_rtx are
6168 assigned and not modified by INSN. */
6169
6170 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
6171 {
6172 int conflicting_input = 0;
6173 int max_input_address_opnum = -1;
6174 int min_conflicting_input_opnum = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS;
6175
6176 if (rld[i].in == 0 || rld[i].when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER
6177 || rld[i].out != 0 || rld[i].reg_rtx == 0
6178 || reg_set_p (rld[i].reg_rtx, insn))
6179 continue;
6180
6181 /* Look at all other reloads. Ensure that the only use of this
6182 reload_reg_rtx is in a reload that just loads the same value
6183 as we do. Note that any secondary reloads must be of the identical
6184 class since the values, modes, and result registers are the
6185 same, so we need not do anything with any secondary reloads. */
6186
6187 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6188 {
6189 if (i == j || rld[j].reg_rtx == 0
6190 || ! reg_overlap_mentioned_p (rld[j].reg_rtx,
6191 rld[i].reg_rtx))
6192 continue;
6193
6194 if (rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6195 && rld[j].opnum > max_input_address_opnum)
6196 max_input_address_opnum = rld[j].opnum;
6197
6198 /* If the reload regs aren't exactly the same (e.g, different modes)
6199 or if the values are different, we can't merge this reload.
6200 But if it is an input reload, we might still merge
6201 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads. */
6202
6203 if (! rtx_equal_p (rld[i].reg_rtx, rld[j].reg_rtx)
6204 || rld[j].out != 0 || rld[j].in == 0
6205 || ! rtx_equal_p (rld[i].in, rld[j].in))
6206 {
6207 if (rld[j].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
6208 || ((rld[i].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6209 || rld[i].opnum > rld[j].opnum)
6210 && rld[i].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS))
6211 break;
6212 conflicting_input = 1;
6213 if (min_conflicting_input_opnum > rld[j].opnum)
6214 min_conflicting_input_opnum = rld[j].opnum;
6215 }
6216 }
6217
6218 /* If all is OK, merge the reloads. Only set this to RELOAD_OTHER if
6219 we, in fact, found any matching reloads. */
6220
6221 if (j == n_reloads
6222 && max_input_address_opnum <= min_conflicting_input_opnum)
6223 {
6224 gcc_assert (rld[i].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT);
6225
6226 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6227 if (i != j && rld[j].reg_rtx != 0
6228 && rtx_equal_p (rld[i].reg_rtx, rld[j].reg_rtx)
6229 && (! conflicting_input
6230 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6231 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS))
6232 {
6233 rld[i].when_needed = RELOAD_OTHER;
6234 rld[j].in = 0;
6235 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
6236 transfer_replacements (i, j);
6237 }
6238
6239 /* If this is now RELOAD_OTHER, look for any reloads that
6240 load parts of this operand and set them to
6241 RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS if they were for inputs,
6242 RELOAD_OTHER for outputs. Note that this test is
6243 equivalent to looking for reloads for this operand
6244 number.
6245
6246 We must take special care with RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS;
6247 it may share registers with a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT, so we can
6248 not change it to RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS. We should
6249 never need to, since we do not modify RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT.
6250
6251 It is possible that the RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
6252 instruction is assigned the same register as the earlier
6253 RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS instruction. Merging these two
6254 instructions will cause the RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
6255 instruction to be deleted later on. */
6256
6257 if (rld[i].when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
6258 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6259 if (rld[j].in != 0
6260 && rld[j].when_needed != RELOAD_OTHER
6261 && rld[j].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
6262 && rld[j].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
6263 && rld[j].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
6264 && (! conflicting_input
6265 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6266 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
6267 && reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (rld[j].in,
6268 rld[i].in))
6269 {
6270 int k;
6271
6272 rld[j].when_needed
6273 = ((rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6274 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
6275 ? RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS : RELOAD_OTHER);
6276
6277 /* Check to see if we accidentally converted two
6278 reloads that use the same reload register with
6279 different inputs to the same type. If so, the
6280 resulting code won't work. */
6281 if (rld[j].reg_rtx)
6282 for (k = 0; k < j; k++)
6283 gcc_assert (rld[k].in == 0 || rld[k].reg_rtx == 0
6284 || rld[k].when_needed != rld[j].when_needed
6285 || !rtx_equal_p (rld[k].reg_rtx,
6286 rld[j].reg_rtx)
6287 || rtx_equal_p (rld[k].in,
6288 rld[j].in));
6289 }
6290 }
6291 }
6292 }
6293
6294 /* These arrays are filled by emit_reload_insns and its subroutines. */
6295 static rtx input_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6296 static rtx other_input_address_reload_insns = 0;
6297 static rtx other_input_reload_insns = 0;
6298 static rtx input_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6299 static rtx inpaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6300 static rtx output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6301 static rtx output_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6302 static rtx outaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6303 static rtx operand_reload_insns = 0;
6304 static rtx other_operand_reload_insns = 0;
6305 static rtx other_output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6306
6307 /* Values to be put in spill_reg_store are put here first. */
6308 static rtx new_spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
6309 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_died;
6310
6311 /* Check if *RELOAD_REG is suitable as an intermediate or scratch register
6312 of class NEW_CLASS with mode NEW_MODE. Or alternatively, if alt_reload_reg
6313 is nonzero, if that is suitable. On success, change *RELOAD_REG to the
6314 adjusted register, and return true. Otherwise, return false. */
6315 static bool
reload_adjust_reg_for_temp(rtx * reload_reg,rtx alt_reload_reg,enum reg_class new_class,enum machine_mode new_mode)6316 reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (rtx *reload_reg, rtx alt_reload_reg,
6317 enum reg_class new_class,
6318 enum machine_mode new_mode)
6319
6320 {
6321 rtx reg;
6322
6323 for (reg = *reload_reg; reg; reg = alt_reload_reg, alt_reload_reg = 0)
6324 {
6325 unsigned regno = REGNO (reg);
6326
6327 if (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) new_class], regno))
6328 continue;
6329 if (GET_MODE (reg) != new_mode)
6330 {
6331 if (!HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, new_mode))
6332 continue;
6333 if (hard_regno_nregs[regno][new_mode]
6334 > hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (reg)])
6335 continue;
6336 reg = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reg, new_mode);
6337 }
6338 *reload_reg = reg;
6339 return true;
6340 }
6341 return false;
6342 }
6343
6344 /* Check if *RELOAD_REG is suitable as a scratch register for the reload
6345 pattern with insn_code ICODE, or alternatively, if alt_reload_reg is
6346 nonzero, if that is suitable. On success, change *RELOAD_REG to the
6347 adjusted register, and return true. Otherwise, return false. */
6348 static bool
reload_adjust_reg_for_icode(rtx * reload_reg,rtx alt_reload_reg,enum insn_code icode)6349 reload_adjust_reg_for_icode (rtx *reload_reg, rtx alt_reload_reg,
6350 enum insn_code icode)
6351
6352 {
6353 enum reg_class new_class = scratch_reload_class (icode);
6354 enum machine_mode new_mode = insn_data[(int) icode].operand[2].mode;
6355
6356 return reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (reload_reg, alt_reload_reg,
6357 new_class, new_mode);
6358 }
6359
6360 /* Generate insns to perform reload RL, which is for the insn in CHAIN and
6361 has the number J. OLD contains the value to be used as input. */
6362
6363 static void
emit_input_reload_insns(struct insn_chain * chain,struct reload * rl,rtx old,int j)6364 emit_input_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl,
6365 rtx old, int j)
6366 {
6367 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6368 rtx reloadreg = rl->reg_rtx;
6369 rtx oldequiv_reg = 0;
6370 rtx oldequiv = 0;
6371 int special = 0;
6372 enum machine_mode mode;
6373 rtx *where;
6374
6375 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
6376 This is very tricky because we have three to choose from.
6377 There is the mode the insn operand wants (rl->inmode).
6378 There is the mode of the reload register RELOADREG.
6379 There is the intrinsic mode of the operand, which we could find
6380 by stripping some SUBREGs.
6381 It turns out that RELOADREG's mode is irrelevant:
6382 we can change that arbitrarily.
6383
6384 Consider (SUBREG:SI foo:QI) as an operand that must be SImode;
6385 then the reload reg may not support QImode moves, so use SImode.
6386 If foo is in memory due to spilling a pseudo reg, this is safe,
6387 because the QImode value is in the least significant part of a
6388 slot big enough for a SImode. If foo is some other sort of
6389 memory reference, then it is impossible to reload this case,
6390 so previous passes had better make sure this never happens.
6391
6392 Then consider a one-word union which has SImode and one of its
6393 members is a float, being fetched as (SUBREG:SF union:SI).
6394 We must fetch that as SFmode because we could be loading into
6395 a float-only register. In this case OLD's mode is correct.
6396
6397 Consider an immediate integer: it has VOIDmode. Here we need
6398 to get a mode from something else.
6399
6400 In some cases, there is a fourth mode, the operand's
6401 containing mode. If the insn specifies a containing mode for
6402 this operand, it overrides all others.
6403
6404 I am not sure whether the algorithm here is always right,
6405 but it does the right things in those cases. */
6406
6407 mode = GET_MODE (old);
6408 if (mode == VOIDmode)
6409 mode = rl->inmode;
6410
6411 /* delete_output_reload is only invoked properly if old contains
6412 the original pseudo register. Since this is replaced with a
6413 hard reg when RELOAD_OVERRIDE_IN is set, see if we can
6414 find the pseudo in RELOAD_IN_REG. */
6415 if (reload_override_in[j]
6416 && REG_P (rl->in_reg))
6417 {
6418 oldequiv = old;
6419 old = rl->in_reg;
6420 }
6421 if (oldequiv == 0)
6422 oldequiv = old;
6423 else if (REG_P (oldequiv))
6424 oldequiv_reg = oldequiv;
6425 else if (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG)
6426 oldequiv_reg = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);
6427
6428 /* If we are reloading from a register that was recently stored in
6429 with an output-reload, see if we can prove there was
6430 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
6431
6432 if (optimize && REG_P (oldequiv)
6433 && REGNO (oldequiv) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6434 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (oldequiv)]
6435 && REG_P (old)
6436 && (dead_or_set_p (insn, spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)])
6437 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)],
6438 rl->out_reg)))
6439 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (oldequiv));
6440
6441 /* Encapsulate both RELOADREG and OLDEQUIV into that mode,
6442 then load RELOADREG from OLDEQUIV. Note that we cannot use
6443 gen_lowpart_common since it can do the wrong thing when
6444 RELOADREG has a multi-word mode. Note that RELOADREG
6445 must always be a REG here. */
6446
6447 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
6448 reloadreg = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reloadreg, mode);
6449 while (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG && GET_MODE (oldequiv) != mode)
6450 oldequiv = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);
6451 if (GET_MODE (oldequiv) != VOIDmode
6452 && mode != GET_MODE (oldequiv))
6453 oldequiv = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, oldequiv);
6454
6455 /* Switch to the right place to emit the reload insns. */
6456 switch (rl->when_needed)
6457 {
6458 case RELOAD_OTHER:
6459 where = &other_input_reload_insns;
6460 break;
6461 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
6462 where = &input_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6463 break;
6464 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
6465 where = &input_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6466 break;
6467 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
6468 where = &inpaddr_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6469 break;
6470 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
6471 where = &output_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6472 break;
6473 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
6474 where = &outaddr_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6475 break;
6476 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
6477 where = &operand_reload_insns;
6478 break;
6479 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
6480 where = &other_operand_reload_insns;
6481 break;
6482 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
6483 where = &other_input_address_reload_insns;
6484 break;
6485 default:
6486 gcc_unreachable ();
6487 }
6488
6489 push_to_sequence (*where);
6490
6491 /* Auto-increment addresses must be reloaded in a special way. */
6492 if (rl->out && ! rl->out_reg)
6493 {
6494 /* We are not going to bother supporting the case where a
6495 incremented register can't be copied directly from
6496 OLDEQUIV since this seems highly unlikely. */
6497 gcc_assert (rl->secondary_in_reload < 0);
6498
6499 if (reload_inherited[j])
6500 oldequiv = reloadreg;
6501
6502 old = XEXP (rl->in_reg, 0);
6503
6504 if (optimize && REG_P (oldequiv)
6505 && REGNO (oldequiv) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6506 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (oldequiv)]
6507 && REG_P (old)
6508 && (dead_or_set_p (insn,
6509 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)])
6510 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)],
6511 old)))
6512 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (oldequiv));
6513
6514 /* Prevent normal processing of this reload. */
6515 special = 1;
6516 /* Output a special code sequence for this case. */
6517 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (reloadreg)]
6518 = inc_for_reload (reloadreg, oldequiv, rl->out,
6519 rl->inc);
6520 }
6521
6522 /* If we are reloading a pseudo-register that was set by the previous
6523 insn, see if we can get rid of that pseudo-register entirely
6524 by redirecting the previous insn into our reload register. */
6525
6526 else if (optimize && REG_P (old)
6527 && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6528 && dead_or_set_p (insn, old)
6529 /* This is unsafe if some other reload
6530 uses the same reg first. */
6531 && ! conflicts_with_override (reloadreg)
6532 && free_for_value_p (REGNO (reloadreg), rl->mode, rl->opnum,
6533 rl->when_needed, old, rl->out, j, 0))
6534 {
6535 rtx temp = PREV_INSN (insn);
6536 while (temp && NOTE_P (temp))
6537 temp = PREV_INSN (temp);
6538 if (temp
6539 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (temp)
6540 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (temp)) == SET
6541 && SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) == old
6542 /* Make sure we can access insn_operand_constraint. */
6543 && asm_noperands (PATTERN (temp)) < 0
6544 /* This is unsafe if operand occurs more than once in current
6545 insn. Perhaps some occurrences aren't reloaded. */
6546 && count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), old, 0) == 1)
6547 {
6548 rtx old = SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp));
6549 /* Store into the reload register instead of the pseudo. */
6550 SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) = reloadreg;
6551
6552 /* Verify that resulting insn is valid. */
6553 extract_insn (temp);
6554 if (constrain_operands (1))
6555 {
6556 /* If the previous insn is an output reload, the source is
6557 a reload register, and its spill_reg_store entry will
6558 contain the previous destination. This is now
6559 invalid. */
6560 if (REG_P (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))
6561 && REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp))) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6562 {
6563 spill_reg_store[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))] = 0;
6564 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))] = 0;
6565 }
6566
6567 /* If these are the only uses of the pseudo reg,
6568 pretend for GDB it lives in the reload reg we used. */
6569 if (REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (old)) == 1
6570 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (old)) == 1)
6571 {
6572 reg_renumber[REGNO (old)] = REGNO (rl->reg_rtx);
6573 alter_reg (REGNO (old), -1);
6574 }
6575 special = 1;
6576 }
6577 else
6578 {
6579 SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) = old;
6580 }
6581 }
6582 }
6583
6584 /* We can't do that, so output an insn to load RELOADREG. */
6585
6586 /* If we have a secondary reload, pick up the secondary register
6587 and icode, if any. If OLDEQUIV and OLD are different or
6588 if this is an in-out reload, recompute whether or not we
6589 still need a secondary register and what the icode should
6590 be. If we still need a secondary register and the class or
6591 icode is different, go back to reloading from OLD if using
6592 OLDEQUIV means that we got the wrong type of register. We
6593 cannot have different class or icode due to an in-out reload
6594 because we don't make such reloads when both the input and
6595 output need secondary reload registers. */
6596
6597 if (! special && rl->secondary_in_reload >= 0)
6598 {
6599 rtx second_reload_reg = 0;
6600 rtx third_reload_reg = 0;
6601 int secondary_reload = rl->secondary_in_reload;
6602 rtx real_oldequiv = oldequiv;
6603 rtx real_old = old;
6604 rtx tmp;
6605 enum insn_code icode;
6606 enum insn_code tertiary_icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
6607
6608 /* If OLDEQUIV is a pseudo with a MEM, get the real MEM
6609 and similarly for OLD.
6610 See comments in get_secondary_reload in reload.c. */
6611 /* If it is a pseudo that cannot be replaced with its
6612 equivalent MEM, we must fall back to reload_in, which
6613 will have all the necessary substitutions registered.
6614 Likewise for a pseudo that can't be replaced with its
6615 equivalent constant.
6616
6617 Take extra care for subregs of such pseudos. Note that
6618 we cannot use reg_equiv_mem in this case because it is
6619 not in the right mode. */
6620
6621 tmp = oldequiv;
6622 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
6623 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
6624 if (REG_P (tmp)
6625 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6626 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)] != 0
6627 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (tmp)] != 0))
6628 {
6629 if (! reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)]
6630 || num_not_at_initial_offset
6631 || GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG)
6632 real_oldequiv = rl->in;
6633 else
6634 real_oldequiv = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)];
6635 }
6636
6637 tmp = old;
6638 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
6639 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
6640 if (REG_P (tmp)
6641 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6642 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)] != 0
6643 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (tmp)] != 0))
6644 {
6645 if (! reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)]
6646 || num_not_at_initial_offset
6647 || GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG)
6648 real_old = rl->in;
6649 else
6650 real_old = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)];
6651 }
6652
6653 second_reload_reg = rld[secondary_reload].reg_rtx;
6654 if (rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_reload >= 0)
6655 {
6656 int tertiary_reload = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_reload;
6657
6658 third_reload_reg = rld[tertiary_reload].reg_rtx;
6659 tertiary_icode = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_icode;
6660 /* We'd have to add more code for quartary reloads. */
6661 gcc_assert (rld[tertiary_reload].secondary_in_reload < 0);
6662 }
6663 icode = rl->secondary_in_icode;
6664
6665 if ((old != oldequiv && ! rtx_equal_p (old, oldequiv))
6666 || (rl->in != 0 && rl->out != 0))
6667 {
6668 secondary_reload_info sri, sri2;
6669 enum reg_class new_class, new_t_class;
6670
6671 sri.icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
6672 sri.prev_sri = NULL;
6673 new_class = targetm.secondary_reload (1, real_oldequiv, rl->class,
6674 mode, &sri);
6675
6676 if (new_class == NO_REGS && sri.icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
6677 second_reload_reg = 0;
6678 else if (new_class == NO_REGS)
6679 {
6680 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_icode (&second_reload_reg,
6681 third_reload_reg, sri.icode))
6682 icode = sri.icode, third_reload_reg = 0;
6683 else
6684 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
6685 }
6686 else if (sri.icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6687 /* We currently lack a way to express this in reloads. */
6688 gcc_unreachable ();
6689 else
6690 {
6691 sri2.icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
6692 sri2.prev_sri = &sri;
6693 new_t_class = targetm.secondary_reload (1, real_oldequiv,
6694 new_class, mode, &sri);
6695 if (new_t_class == NO_REGS && sri2.icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
6696 {
6697 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&second_reload_reg,
6698 third_reload_reg,
6699 new_class, mode))
6700 third_reload_reg = 0, tertiary_icode = sri2.icode;
6701 else
6702 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
6703 }
6704 else if (new_t_class == NO_REGS && sri2.icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6705 {
6706 rtx intermediate = second_reload_reg;
6707
6708 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&intermediate, NULL,
6709 new_class, mode)
6710 && reload_adjust_reg_for_icode (&third_reload_reg, NULL,
6711 sri2.icode))
6712 {
6713 second_reload_reg = intermediate;
6714 tertiary_icode = sri2.icode;
6715 }
6716 else
6717 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
6718 }
6719 else if (new_t_class != NO_REGS && sri2.icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
6720 {
6721 rtx intermediate = second_reload_reg;
6722
6723 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&intermediate, NULL,
6724 new_class, mode)
6725 && reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&third_reload_reg, NULL,
6726 new_t_class, mode))
6727 {
6728 second_reload_reg = intermediate;
6729 tertiary_icode = sri2.icode;
6730 }
6731 else
6732 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
6733 }
6734 else
6735 /* This could be handled more intelligently too. */
6736 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
6737 }
6738 }
6739
6740 /* If we still need a secondary reload register, check
6741 to see if it is being used as a scratch or intermediate
6742 register and generate code appropriately. If we need
6743 a scratch register, use REAL_OLDEQUIV since the form of
6744 the insn may depend on the actual address if it is
6745 a MEM. */
6746
6747 if (second_reload_reg)
6748 {
6749 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6750 {
6751 /* We'd have to add extra code to handle this case. */
6752 gcc_assert (!third_reload_reg);
6753
6754 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (reloadreg, real_oldequiv,
6755 second_reload_reg));
6756 special = 1;
6757 }
6758 else
6759 {
6760 /* See if we need a scratch register to load the
6761 intermediate register (a tertiary reload). */
6762 if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6763 {
6764 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
6765 (second_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
6766 third_reload_reg)));
6767 }
6768 else if (third_reload_reg)
6769 {
6770 gen_reload (third_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
6771 rl->opnum,
6772 rl->when_needed);
6773 gen_reload (second_reload_reg, third_reload_reg,
6774 rl->opnum,
6775 rl->when_needed);
6776 }
6777 else
6778 gen_reload (second_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
6779 rl->opnum,
6780 rl->when_needed);
6781
6782 oldequiv = second_reload_reg;
6783 }
6784 }
6785 }
6786
6787 if (! special && ! rtx_equal_p (reloadreg, oldequiv))
6788 {
6789 rtx real_oldequiv = oldequiv;
6790
6791 if ((REG_P (oldequiv)
6792 && REGNO (oldequiv) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6793 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (oldequiv)] != 0
6794 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (oldequiv)] != 0))
6795 || (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG
6796 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))
6797 && (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))
6798 >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6799 && ((reg_equiv_memory_loc
6800 [REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))] != 0)
6801 || (reg_equiv_constant
6802 [REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))] != 0)))
6803 || (CONSTANT_P (oldequiv)
6804 && (PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (oldequiv,
6805 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (reloadreg)))
6806 == NO_REGS)))
6807 real_oldequiv = rl->in;
6808 gen_reload (reloadreg, real_oldequiv, rl->opnum,
6809 rl->when_needed);
6810 }
6811
6812 if (flag_non_call_exceptions)
6813 copy_eh_notes (insn, get_insns ());
6814
6815 /* End this sequence. */
6816 *where = get_insns ();
6817 end_sequence ();
6818
6819 /* Update reload_override_in so that delete_address_reloads_1
6820 can see the actual register usage. */
6821 if (oldequiv_reg)
6822 reload_override_in[j] = oldequiv;
6823 }
6824
6825 /* Generate insns to for the output reload RL, which is for the insn described
6826 by CHAIN and has the number J. */
6827 static void
emit_output_reload_insns(struct insn_chain * chain,struct reload * rl,int j)6828 emit_output_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl,
6829 int j)
6830 {
6831 rtx reloadreg = rl->reg_rtx;
6832 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6833 int special = 0;
6834 rtx old = rl->out;
6835 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (old);
6836 rtx p;
6837
6838 if (rl->when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
6839 start_sequence ();
6840 else
6841 push_to_sequence (output_reload_insns[rl->opnum]);
6842
6843 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
6844 See comments above (for input reloading). */
6845
6846 if (mode == VOIDmode)
6847 {
6848 /* VOIDmode should never happen for an output. */
6849 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
6850 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
6851 fatal_insn ("VOIDmode on an output", insn);
6852 error_for_asm (insn, "output operand is constant in %<asm%>");
6853 /* Prevent crash--use something we know is valid. */
6854 mode = word_mode;
6855 old = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reloadreg));
6856 }
6857
6858 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
6859 reloadreg = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reloadreg, mode);
6860
6861 /* If we need two reload regs, set RELOADREG to the intermediate
6862 one, since it will be stored into OLD. We might need a secondary
6863 register only for an input reload, so check again here. */
6864
6865 if (rl->secondary_out_reload >= 0)
6866 {
6867 rtx real_old = old;
6868 int secondary_reload = rl->secondary_out_reload;
6869 int tertiary_reload = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_out_reload;
6870
6871 if (REG_P (old) && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6872 && reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)] != 0)
6873 real_old = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)];
6874
6875 if (secondary_reload_class (0, rl->class, mode, real_old) != NO_REGS)
6876 {
6877 rtx second_reloadreg = reloadreg;
6878 reloadreg = rld[secondary_reload].reg_rtx;
6879
6880 /* See if RELOADREG is to be used as a scratch register
6881 or as an intermediate register. */
6882 if (rl->secondary_out_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6883 {
6884 /* We'd have to add extra code to handle this case. */
6885 gcc_assert (tertiary_reload < 0);
6886
6887 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (rl->secondary_out_icode)
6888 (real_old, second_reloadreg, reloadreg)));
6889 special = 1;
6890 }
6891 else
6892 {
6893 /* See if we need both a scratch and intermediate reload
6894 register. */
6895
6896 enum insn_code tertiary_icode
6897 = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_out_icode;
6898
6899 /* We'd have to add more code for quartary reloads. */
6900 gcc_assert (tertiary_reload < 0
6901 || rld[tertiary_reload].secondary_out_reload < 0);
6902
6903 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
6904 reloadreg = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reloadreg, mode);
6905
6906 if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6907 {
6908 rtx third_reloadreg = rld[tertiary_reload].reg_rtx;
6909 rtx tem;
6910
6911 /* Copy primary reload reg to secondary reload reg.
6912 (Note that these have been swapped above, then
6913 secondary reload reg to OLD using our insn.) */
6914
6915 /* If REAL_OLD is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it
6916 and try to put the opposite SUBREG on
6917 RELOADREG. */
6918 if (GET_CODE (real_old) == SUBREG
6919 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (real_old))
6920 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old))))
6921 && 0 != (tem = gen_lowpart_common
6922 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old)),
6923 reloadreg)))
6924 real_old = SUBREG_REG (real_old), reloadreg = tem;
6925
6926 gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
6927 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
6928 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
6929 (real_old, reloadreg, third_reloadreg)));
6930 special = 1;
6931 }
6932
6933 else
6934 {
6935 /* Copy between the reload regs here and then to
6936 OUT later. */
6937
6938 gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
6939 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
6940 if (tertiary_reload >= 0)
6941 {
6942 rtx third_reloadreg = rld[tertiary_reload].reg_rtx;
6943
6944 gen_reload (third_reloadreg, reloadreg,
6945 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
6946 reloadreg = third_reloadreg;
6947 }
6948 }
6949 }
6950 }
6951 }
6952
6953 /* Output the last reload insn. */
6954 if (! special)
6955 {
6956 rtx set;
6957
6958 /* Don't output the last reload if OLD is not the dest of
6959 INSN and is in the src and is clobbered by INSN. */
6960 if (! flag_expensive_optimizations
6961 || !REG_P (old)
6962 || !(set = single_set (insn))
6963 || rtx_equal_p (old, SET_DEST (set))
6964 || !reg_mentioned_p (old, SET_SRC (set))
6965 || !((REGNO (old) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6966 && regno_clobbered_p (REGNO (old), insn, rl->mode, 0)))
6967 gen_reload (old, reloadreg, rl->opnum,
6968 rl->when_needed);
6969 }
6970
6971 /* Look at all insns we emitted, just to be safe. */
6972 for (p = get_insns (); p; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
6973 if (INSN_P (p))
6974 {
6975 rtx pat = PATTERN (p);
6976
6977 /* If this output reload doesn't come from a spill reg,
6978 clear any memory of reloaded copies of the pseudo reg.
6979 If this output reload comes from a spill reg,
6980 reg_has_output_reload will make this do nothing. */
6981 note_stores (pat, forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
6982
6983 if (reg_mentioned_p (rl->reg_rtx, pat))
6984 {
6985 rtx set = single_set (insn);
6986 if (reload_spill_index[j] < 0
6987 && set
6988 && SET_SRC (set) == rl->reg_rtx)
6989 {
6990 int src = REGNO (SET_SRC (set));
6991
6992 reload_spill_index[j] = src;
6993 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, src);
6994 if (find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, src))
6995 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src);
6996 }
6997 if (REGNO (rl->reg_rtx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6998 {
6999 int s = rl->secondary_out_reload;
7000 set = single_set (p);
7001 /* If this reload copies only to the secondary reload
7002 register, the secondary reload does the actual
7003 store. */
7004 if (s >= 0 && set == NULL_RTX)
7005 /* We can't tell what function the secondary reload
7006 has and where the actual store to the pseudo is
7007 made; leave new_spill_reg_store alone. */
7008 ;
7009 else if (s >= 0
7010 && SET_SRC (set) == rl->reg_rtx
7011 && SET_DEST (set) == rld[s].reg_rtx)
7012 {
7013 /* Usually the next instruction will be the
7014 secondary reload insn; if we can confirm
7015 that it is, setting new_spill_reg_store to
7016 that insn will allow an extra optimization. */
7017 rtx s_reg = rld[s].reg_rtx;
7018 rtx next = NEXT_INSN (p);
7019 rld[s].out = rl->out;
7020 rld[s].out_reg = rl->out_reg;
7021 set = single_set (next);
7022 if (set && SET_SRC (set) == s_reg
7023 && ! new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (s_reg)])
7024 {
7025 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
7026 REGNO (s_reg));
7027 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (s_reg)] = next;
7028 }
7029 }
7030 else
7031 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)] = p;
7032 }
7033 }
7034 }
7035
7036 if (rl->when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
7037 {
7038 emit_insn (other_output_reload_insns[rl->opnum]);
7039 other_output_reload_insns[rl->opnum] = get_insns ();
7040 }
7041 else
7042 output_reload_insns[rl->opnum] = get_insns ();
7043
7044 if (flag_non_call_exceptions)
7045 copy_eh_notes (insn, get_insns ());
7046
7047 end_sequence ();
7048 }
7049
7050 /* Do input reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by CHAIN
7051 and has the number J. */
7052 static void
do_input_reload(struct insn_chain * chain,struct reload * rl,int j)7053 do_input_reload (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl, int j)
7054 {
7055 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7056 rtx old = (rl->in && MEM_P (rl->in)
7057 ? rl->in_reg : rl->in);
7058
7059 if (old != 0
7060 /* AUTO_INC reloads need to be handled even if inherited. We got an
7061 AUTO_INC reload if reload_out is set but reload_out_reg isn't. */
7062 && (! reload_inherited[j] || (rl->out && ! rl->out_reg))
7063 && ! rtx_equal_p (rl->reg_rtx, old)
7064 && rl->reg_rtx != 0)
7065 emit_input_reload_insns (chain, rld + j, old, j);
7066
7067 /* When inheriting a wider reload, we have a MEM in rl->in,
7068 e.g. inheriting a SImode output reload for
7069 (mem:HI (plus:SI (reg:SI 14 fp) (const_int 10))) */
7070 if (optimize && reload_inherited[j] && rl->in
7071 && MEM_P (rl->in)
7072 && MEM_P (rl->in_reg)
7073 && reload_spill_index[j] >= 0
7074 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, reload_spill_index[j]))
7075 rl->in = regno_reg_rtx[reg_reloaded_contents[reload_spill_index[j]]];
7076
7077 /* If we are reloading a register that was recently stored in with an
7078 output-reload, see if we can prove there was
7079 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
7080
7081 if (optimize
7082 /* Only attempt this for input reloads; for RELOAD_OTHER we miss
7083 that there may be multiple uses of the previous output reload.
7084 Restricting to RELOAD_FOR_INPUT is mostly paranoia. */
7085 && rl->when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
7086 && (reload_inherited[j] || reload_override_in[j])
7087 && rl->reg_rtx
7088 && REG_P (rl->reg_rtx)
7089 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)] != 0
7090 #if 0
7091 /* There doesn't seem to be any reason to restrict this to pseudos
7092 and doing so loses in the case where we are copying from a
7093 register of the wrong class. */
7094 && (REGNO (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)])
7095 >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7096 #endif
7097 /* The insn might have already some references to stackslots
7098 replaced by MEMs, while reload_out_reg still names the
7099 original pseudo. */
7100 && (dead_or_set_p (insn,
7101 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)])
7102 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (rl->reg_rtx)],
7103 rl->out_reg)))
7104 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (rl->reg_rtx));
7105 }
7106
7107 /* Do output reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by
7108 CHAIN and has the number J.
7109 ??? At some point we need to support handling output reloads of
7110 JUMP_INSNs or insns that set cc0. */
7111 static void
do_output_reload(struct insn_chain * chain,struct reload * rl,int j)7112 do_output_reload (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl, int j)
7113 {
7114 rtx note, old;
7115 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7116 /* If this is an output reload that stores something that is
7117 not loaded in this same reload, see if we can eliminate a previous
7118 store. */
7119 rtx pseudo = rl->out_reg;
7120
7121 if (pseudo
7122 && optimize
7123 && REG_P (pseudo)
7124 && ! rtx_equal_p (rl->in_reg, pseudo)
7125 && REGNO (pseudo) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7126 && reg_last_reload_reg[REGNO (pseudo)])
7127 {
7128 int pseudo_no = REGNO (pseudo);
7129 int last_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[pseudo_no]);
7130
7131 /* We don't need to test full validity of last_regno for
7132 inherit here; we only want to know if the store actually
7133 matches the pseudo. */
7134 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, last_regno)
7135 && reg_reloaded_contents[last_regno] == pseudo_no
7136 && spill_reg_store[last_regno]
7137 && rtx_equal_p (pseudo, spill_reg_stored_to[last_regno]))
7138 delete_output_reload (insn, j, last_regno);
7139 }
7140
7141 old = rl->out_reg;
7142 if (old == 0
7143 || rl->reg_rtx == old
7144 || rl->reg_rtx == 0)
7145 return;
7146
7147 /* An output operand that dies right away does need a reload,
7148 but need not be copied from it. Show the new location in the
7149 REG_UNUSED note. */
7150 if ((REG_P (old) || GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
7151 && (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED, old)) != 0)
7152 {
7153 XEXP (note, 0) = rl->reg_rtx;
7154 return;
7155 }
7156 /* Likewise for a SUBREG of an operand that dies. */
7157 else if (GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG
7158 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (old))
7159 && 0 != (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED,
7160 SUBREG_REG (old))))
7161 {
7162 XEXP (note, 0) = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (old),
7163 rl->reg_rtx);
7164 return;
7165 }
7166 else if (GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
7167 /* If we aren't optimizing, there won't be a REG_UNUSED note,
7168 but we don't want to make an output reload. */
7169 return;
7170
7171 /* If is a JUMP_INSN, we can't support output reloads yet. */
7172 gcc_assert (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn));
7173
7174 emit_output_reload_insns (chain, rld + j, j);
7175 }
7176
7177 /* Reload number R reloads from or to a group of hard registers starting at
7178 register REGNO. Return true if it can be treated for inheritance purposes
7179 like a group of reloads, each one reloading a single hard register.
7180 The caller has already checked that the spill register and REGNO use
7181 the same number of registers to store the reload value. */
7182
7183 static bool
inherit_piecemeal_p(int r ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,int regno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)7184 inherit_piecemeal_p (int r ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int regno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7185 {
7186 #ifdef CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS
7187 return (!REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (reload_spill_index[r],
7188 GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx),
7189 reg_raw_mode[reload_spill_index[r]])
7190 && !REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (regno,
7191 GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx),
7192 reg_raw_mode[regno]));
7193 #else
7194 return true;
7195 #endif
7196 }
7197
7198 /* Output insns to reload values in and out of the chosen reload regs. */
7199
7200 static void
emit_reload_insns(struct insn_chain * chain)7201 emit_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *chain)
7202 {
7203 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7204
7205 int j;
7206
7207 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_died);
7208
7209 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
7210 input_reload_insns[j] = input_address_reload_insns[j]
7211 = inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
7212 = output_reload_insns[j] = output_address_reload_insns[j]
7213 = outaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
7214 = other_output_reload_insns[j] = 0;
7215 other_input_address_reload_insns = 0;
7216 other_input_reload_insns = 0;
7217 operand_reload_insns = 0;
7218 other_operand_reload_insns = 0;
7219
7220 /* Dump reloads into the dump file. */
7221 if (dump_file)
7222 {
7223 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReloads for insn # %d\n", INSN_UID (insn));
7224 debug_reload_to_stream (dump_file);
7225 }
7226
7227 /* Now output the instructions to copy the data into and out of the
7228 reload registers. Do these in the order that the reloads were reported,
7229 since reloads of base and index registers precede reloads of operands
7230 and the operands may need the base and index registers reloaded. */
7231
7232 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
7233 {
7234 if (rld[j].reg_rtx
7235 && REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7236 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx)] = 0;
7237
7238 do_input_reload (chain, rld + j, j);
7239 do_output_reload (chain, rld + j, j);
7240 }
7241
7242 /* Now write all the insns we made for reloads in the order expected by
7243 the allocation functions. Prior to the insn being reloaded, we write
7244 the following reloads:
7245
7246 RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads for input addresses.
7247
7248 RELOAD_OTHER reloads.
7249
7250 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
7251 by any RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reloads followed by the
7252 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for the operand.
7253
7254 RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDRS reloads.
7255
7256 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads.
7257
7258 After the insn being reloaded, we write the following:
7259
7260 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
7261 by any RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload followed by the
7262 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload, followed by any RELOAD_OTHER output
7263 reloads for the operand. The RELOAD_OTHER output reloads are
7264 output in descending order by reload number. */
7265
7266 emit_insn_before (other_input_address_reload_insns, insn);
7267 emit_insn_before (other_input_reload_insns, insn);
7268
7269 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
7270 {
7271 emit_insn_before (inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
7272 emit_insn_before (input_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
7273 emit_insn_before (input_reload_insns[j], insn);
7274 }
7275
7276 emit_insn_before (other_operand_reload_insns, insn);
7277 emit_insn_before (operand_reload_insns, insn);
7278
7279 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
7280 {
7281 rtx x = emit_insn_after (outaddr_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
7282 x = emit_insn_after (output_address_reload_insns[j], x);
7283 x = emit_insn_after (output_reload_insns[j], x);
7284 emit_insn_after (other_output_reload_insns[j], x);
7285 }
7286
7287 /* For all the spill regs newly reloaded in this instruction,
7288 record what they were reloaded from, so subsequent instructions
7289 can inherit the reloads.
7290
7291 Update spill_reg_store for the reloads of this insn.
7292 Copy the elements that were updated in the loop above. */
7293
7294 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
7295 {
7296 int r = reload_order[j];
7297 int i = reload_spill_index[r];
7298
7299 /* If this is a non-inherited input reload from a pseudo, we must
7300 clear any memory of a previous store to the same pseudo. Only do
7301 something if there will not be an output reload for the pseudo
7302 being reloaded. */
7303 if (rld[r].in_reg != 0
7304 && ! (reload_inherited[r] || reload_override_in[r]))
7305 {
7306 rtx reg = rld[r].in_reg;
7307
7308 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
7309 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
7310
7311 if (REG_P (reg)
7312 && REGNO (reg) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7313 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P (®_has_output_reload, REGNO (reg)))
7314 {
7315 int nregno = REGNO (reg);
7316
7317 if (reg_last_reload_reg[nregno])
7318 {
7319 int last_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[nregno]);
7320
7321 if (reg_reloaded_contents[last_regno] == nregno)
7322 spill_reg_store[last_regno] = 0;
7323 }
7324 }
7325 }
7326
7327 /* I is nonneg if this reload used a register.
7328 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
7329 that we opted to ignore. */
7330
7331 if (i >= 0 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0)
7332 {
7333 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[i][GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx)];
7334 int k;
7335 int part_reaches_end = 0;
7336 int all_reaches_end = 1;
7337
7338 /* For a multi register reload, we need to check if all or part
7339 of the value lives to the end. */
7340 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
7341 {
7342 if (reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i + k, rld[r].opnum,
7343 rld[r].when_needed))
7344 part_reaches_end = 1;
7345 else
7346 all_reaches_end = 0;
7347 }
7348
7349 /* Ignore reloads that don't reach the end of the insn in
7350 entirety. */
7351 if (all_reaches_end)
7352 {
7353 /* First, clear out memory of what used to be in this spill reg.
7354 If consecutive registers are used, clear them all. */
7355
7356 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
7357 {
7358 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
7359 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered, i + k);
7360 }
7361
7362 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_out. */
7363 if (rld[r].out != 0
7364 && (REG_P (rld[r].out)
7365 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
7366 || ! rld[r].out_reg
7367 #endif
7368 || REG_P (rld[r].out_reg)))
7369 {
7370 rtx out = (REG_P (rld[r].out)
7371 ? rld[r].out
7372 : rld[r].out_reg
7373 ? rld[r].out_reg
7374 /* AUTO_INC */ : XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
7375 int nregno = REGNO (out);
7376 int nnr = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER ? 1
7377 : hard_regno_nregs[nregno]
7378 [GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx)]);
7379 bool piecemeal;
7380
7381 spill_reg_store[i] = new_spill_reg_store[i];
7382 spill_reg_stored_to[i] = out;
7383 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = rld[r].reg_rtx;
7384
7385 piecemeal = (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7386 && nr == nnr
7387 && inherit_piecemeal_p (r, nregno));
7388
7389 /* If NREGNO is a hard register, it may occupy more than
7390 one register. If it does, say what is in the
7391 rest of the registers assuming that both registers
7392 agree on how many words the object takes. If not,
7393 invalidate the subsequent registers. */
7394
7395 if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7396 for (k = 1; k < nnr; k++)
7397 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno + k]
7398 = (piecemeal
7399 ? regno_reg_rtx[REGNO (rld[r].reg_rtx) + k]
7400 : 0);
7401
7402 /* Now do the inverse operation. */
7403 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
7404 {
7405 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i + k);
7406 reg_reloaded_contents[i + k]
7407 = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || !piecemeal
7408 ? nregno
7409 : nregno + k);
7410 reg_reloaded_insn[i + k] = insn;
7411 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
7412 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i + k, GET_MODE (out)))
7413 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered, i + k);
7414 }
7415 }
7416
7417 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_in. Only do
7418 something if there will not be an output reload for
7419 the register being reloaded. */
7420 else if (rld[r].out_reg == 0
7421 && rld[r].in != 0
7422 && ((REG_P (rld[r].in)
7423 && REGNO (rld[r].in) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7424 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P (®_has_output_reload,
7425 REGNO (rld[r].in)))
7426 || (REG_P (rld[r].in_reg)
7427 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P (®_has_output_reload,
7428 REGNO (rld[r].in_reg))))
7429 && ! reg_set_p (rld[r].reg_rtx, PATTERN (insn)))
7430 {
7431 int nregno;
7432 int nnr;
7433 rtx in;
7434 bool piecemeal;
7435
7436 if (REG_P (rld[r].in)
7437 && REGNO (rld[r].in) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7438 in = rld[r].in;
7439 else if (REG_P (rld[r].in_reg))
7440 in = rld[r].in_reg;
7441 else
7442 in = XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0);
7443 nregno = REGNO (in);
7444
7445 nnr = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER ? 1
7446 : hard_regno_nregs[nregno]
7447 [GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx)]);
7448
7449 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = rld[r].reg_rtx;
7450
7451 piecemeal = (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7452 && nr == nnr
7453 && inherit_piecemeal_p (r, nregno));
7454
7455 if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7456 for (k = 1; k < nnr; k++)
7457 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno + k]
7458 = (piecemeal
7459 ? regno_reg_rtx[REGNO (rld[r].reg_rtx) + k]
7460 : 0);
7461
7462 /* Unless we inherited this reload, show we haven't
7463 recently done a store.
7464 Previous stores of inherited auto_inc expressions
7465 also have to be discarded. */
7466 if (! reload_inherited[r]
7467 || (rld[r].out && ! rld[r].out_reg))
7468 spill_reg_store[i] = 0;
7469
7470 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
7471 {
7472 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i + k);
7473 reg_reloaded_contents[i + k]
7474 = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || !piecemeal
7475 ? nregno
7476 : nregno + k);
7477 reg_reloaded_insn[i + k] = insn;
7478 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
7479 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i + k, GET_MODE (in)))
7480 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered, i + k);
7481 }
7482 }
7483 }
7484
7485 /* However, if part of the reload reaches the end, then we must
7486 invalidate the old info for the part that survives to the end. */
7487 else if (part_reaches_end)
7488 {
7489 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
7490 if (reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i + k,
7491 rld[r].opnum,
7492 rld[r].when_needed))
7493 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
7494 }
7495 }
7496
7497 /* The following if-statement was #if 0'd in 1.34 (or before...).
7498 It's reenabled in 1.35 because supposedly nothing else
7499 deals with this problem. */
7500
7501 /* If a register gets output-reloaded from a non-spill register,
7502 that invalidates any previous reloaded copy of it.
7503 But forget_old_reloads_1 won't get to see it, because
7504 it thinks only about the original insn. So invalidate it here.
7505 Also do the same thing for RELOAD_OTHER constraints where the
7506 output is discarded. */
7507 if (i < 0
7508 && ((rld[r].out != 0
7509 && (REG_P (rld[r].out)
7510 || (MEM_P (rld[r].out)
7511 && REG_P (rld[r].out_reg))))
7512 || (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].out_reg
7513 && REG_P (rld[r].out_reg))))
7514 {
7515 rtx out = ((rld[r].out && REG_P (rld[r].out))
7516 ? rld[r].out : rld[r].out_reg);
7517 int nregno = REGNO (out);
7518 if (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7519 {
7520 rtx src_reg, store_insn = NULL_RTX;
7521
7522 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = 0;
7523
7524 /* If we can find a hard register that is stored, record
7525 the storing insn so that we may delete this insn with
7526 delete_output_reload. */
7527 src_reg = rld[r].reg_rtx;
7528
7529 /* If this is an optional reload, try to find the source reg
7530 from an input reload. */
7531 if (! src_reg)
7532 {
7533 rtx set = single_set (insn);
7534 if (set && SET_DEST (set) == rld[r].out)
7535 {
7536 int k;
7537
7538 src_reg = SET_SRC (set);
7539 store_insn = insn;
7540 for (k = 0; k < n_reloads; k++)
7541 {
7542 if (rld[k].in == src_reg)
7543 {
7544 src_reg = rld[k].reg_rtx;
7545 break;
7546 }
7547 }
7548 }
7549 }
7550 else
7551 store_insn = new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (src_reg)];
7552 if (src_reg && REG_P (src_reg)
7553 && REGNO (src_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7554 {
7555 int src_regno = REGNO (src_reg);
7556 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[src_regno][rld[r].mode];
7557 /* The place where to find a death note varies with
7558 PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P . The condition is not
7559 necessarily checked exactly in the code that moves
7560 notes, so just check both locations. */
7561 rtx note = find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, src_regno);
7562 if (! note && store_insn)
7563 note = find_regno_note (store_insn, REG_DEAD, src_regno);
7564 while (nr-- > 0)
7565 {
7566 spill_reg_store[src_regno + nr] = store_insn;
7567 spill_reg_stored_to[src_regno + nr] = out;
7568 reg_reloaded_contents[src_regno + nr] = nregno;
7569 reg_reloaded_insn[src_regno + nr] = store_insn;
7570 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, src_regno + nr);
7571 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, src_regno + nr);
7572 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (src_regno + nr,
7573 GET_MODE (src_reg)))
7574 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
7575 src_regno + nr);
7576 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, src_regno + nr);
7577 if (note)
7578 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src_regno);
7579 else
7580 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src_regno);
7581 }
7582 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = src_reg;
7583 /* We have to set reg_has_output_reload here, or else
7584 forget_old_reloads_1 will clear reg_last_reload_reg
7585 right away. */
7586 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (®_has_output_reload,
7587 nregno);
7588 }
7589 }
7590 else
7591 {
7592 int num_regs = hard_regno_nregs[nregno][GET_MODE (out)];
7593
7594 while (num_regs-- > 0)
7595 reg_last_reload_reg[nregno + num_regs] = 0;
7596 }
7597 }
7598 }
7599 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_dead, reg_reloaded_died);
7600 }
7601
7602 /* Go through the motions to emit INSN and test if it is strictly valid.
7603 Return the emitted insn if valid, else return NULL. */
7604
7605 static rtx
emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload(rtx insn)7606 emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (rtx insn)
7607 {
7608 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
7609 int code;
7610
7611 insn = emit_insn (insn);
7612 code = recog_memoized (insn);
7613
7614 if (code >= 0)
7615 {
7616 extract_insn (insn);
7617 /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in its
7618 validity determination, i.e., the way it would after reload has
7619 completed. */
7620 if (constrain_operands (1))
7621 return insn;
7622 }
7623
7624 delete_insns_since (last);
7625 return NULL;
7626 }
7627
7628 /* Emit code to perform a reload from IN (which may be a reload register) to
7629 OUT (which may also be a reload register). IN or OUT is from operand
7630 OPNUM with reload type TYPE.
7631
7632 Returns first insn emitted. */
7633
7634 static rtx
gen_reload(rtx out,rtx in,int opnum,enum reload_type type)7635 gen_reload (rtx out, rtx in, int opnum, enum reload_type type)
7636 {
7637 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
7638 rtx tem;
7639
7640 /* If IN is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it and try to put the
7641 opposite SUBREG on OUT. Likewise for a paradoxical SUBREG on OUT. */
7642 if (GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG
7643 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (in))
7644 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in))))
7645 && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in)), out)) != 0)
7646 in = SUBREG_REG (in), out = tem;
7647 else if (GET_CODE (out) == SUBREG
7648 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (out))
7649 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out))))
7650 && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out)), in)) != 0)
7651 out = SUBREG_REG (out), in = tem;
7652
7653 /* How to do this reload can get quite tricky. Normally, we are being
7654 asked to reload a simple operand, such as a MEM, a constant, or a pseudo
7655 register that didn't get a hard register. In that case we can just
7656 call emit_move_insn.
7657
7658 We can also be asked to reload a PLUS that adds a register or a MEM to
7659 another register, constant or MEM. This can occur during frame pointer
7660 elimination and while reloading addresses. This case is handled by
7661 trying to emit a single insn to perform the add. If it is not valid,
7662 we use a two insn sequence.
7663
7664 Or we can be asked to reload an unary operand that was a fragment of
7665 an addressing mode, into a register. If it isn't recognized as-is,
7666 we try making the unop operand and the reload-register the same:
7667 (set reg:X (unop:X expr:Y))
7668 -> (set reg:Y expr:Y) (set reg:X (unop:X reg:Y)).
7669
7670 Finally, we could be called to handle an 'o' constraint by putting
7671 an address into a register. In that case, we first try to do this
7672 with a named pattern of "reload_load_address". If no such pattern
7673 exists, we just emit a SET insn and hope for the best (it will normally
7674 be valid on machines that use 'o').
7675
7676 This entire process is made complex because reload will never
7677 process the insns we generate here and so we must ensure that
7678 they will fit their constraints and also by the fact that parts of
7679 IN might be being reloaded separately and replaced with spill registers.
7680 Because of this, we are, in some sense, just guessing the right approach
7681 here. The one listed above seems to work.
7682
7683 ??? At some point, this whole thing needs to be rethought. */
7684
7685 if (GET_CODE (in) == PLUS
7686 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 0))
7687 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == SUBREG
7688 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 0)))
7689 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 1))
7690 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == SUBREG
7691 || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (in, 1))
7692 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 1))))
7693 {
7694 /* We need to compute the sum of a register or a MEM and another
7695 register, constant, or MEM, and put it into the reload
7696 register. The best possible way of doing this is if the machine
7697 has a three-operand ADD insn that accepts the required operands.
7698
7699 The simplest approach is to try to generate such an insn and see if it
7700 is recognized and matches its constraints. If so, it can be used.
7701
7702 It might be better not to actually emit the insn unless it is valid,
7703 but we need to pass the insn as an operand to `recog' and
7704 `extract_insn' and it is simpler to emit and then delete the insn if
7705 not valid than to dummy things up. */
7706
7707 rtx op0, op1, tem, insn;
7708 int code;
7709
7710 op0 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 0));
7711 op1 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 1));
7712
7713 /* Since constraint checking is strict, commutativity won't be
7714 checked, so we need to do that here to avoid spurious failure
7715 if the add instruction is two-address and the second operand
7716 of the add is the same as the reload reg, which is frequently
7717 the case. If the insn would be A = B + A, rearrange it so
7718 it will be A = A + B as constrain_operands expects. */
7719
7720 if (REG_P (XEXP (in, 1))
7721 && REGNO (out) == REGNO (XEXP (in, 1)))
7722 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
7723
7724 if (op0 != XEXP (in, 0) || op1 != XEXP (in, 1))
7725 in = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (in), op0, op1);
7726
7727 insn = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
7728 if (insn)
7729 return insn;
7730
7731 /* If that failed, we must use a conservative two-insn sequence.
7732
7733 Use a move to copy one operand into the reload register. Prefer
7734 to reload a constant, MEM or pseudo since the move patterns can
7735 handle an arbitrary operand. If OP1 is not a constant, MEM or
7736 pseudo and OP1 is not a valid operand for an add instruction, then
7737 reload OP1.
7738
7739 After reloading one of the operands into the reload register, add
7740 the reload register to the output register.
7741
7742 If there is another way to do this for a specific machine, a
7743 DEFINE_PEEPHOLE should be specified that recognizes the sequence
7744 we emit below. */
7745
7746 code = (int) add_optab->handlers[(int) GET_MODE (out)].insn_code;
7747
7748 if (CONSTANT_P (op1) || MEM_P (op1) || GET_CODE (op1) == SUBREG
7749 || (REG_P (op1)
7750 && REGNO (op1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7751 || (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
7752 && ! ((*insn_data[code].operand[2].predicate)
7753 (op1, insn_data[code].operand[2].mode))))
7754 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
7755
7756 gen_reload (out, op0, opnum, type);
7757
7758 /* If OP0 and OP1 are the same, we can use OUT for OP1.
7759 This fixes a problem on the 32K where the stack pointer cannot
7760 be used as an operand of an add insn. */
7761
7762 if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1))
7763 op1 = out;
7764
7765 insn = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (gen_add2_insn (out, op1));
7766 if (insn)
7767 {
7768 /* Add a REG_EQUIV note so that find_equiv_reg can find it. */
7769 REG_NOTES (insn)
7770 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV, in, REG_NOTES (insn));
7771 return insn;
7772 }
7773
7774 /* If that failed, copy the address register to the reload register.
7775 Then add the constant to the reload register. */
7776
7777 gen_reload (out, op1, opnum, type);
7778 insn = emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (out, op0));
7779 REG_NOTES (insn) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV, in, REG_NOTES (insn));
7780 }
7781
7782 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
7783 /* If we need a memory location to do the move, do it that way. */
7784 else if ((REG_P (in) || GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG)
7785 && reg_or_subregno (in) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7786 && (REG_P (out) || GET_CODE (out) == SUBREG)
7787 && reg_or_subregno (out) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7788 && SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (REGNO_REG_CLASS (reg_or_subregno (in)),
7789 REGNO_REG_CLASS (reg_or_subregno (out)),
7790 GET_MODE (out)))
7791 {
7792 /* Get the memory to use and rewrite both registers to its mode. */
7793 rtx loc = get_secondary_mem (in, GET_MODE (out), opnum, type);
7794
7795 if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (out))
7796 out = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), REGNO (out));
7797
7798 if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (in))
7799 in = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), REGNO (in));
7800
7801 gen_reload (loc, in, opnum, type);
7802 gen_reload (out, loc, opnum, type);
7803 }
7804 #endif
7805 else if (REG_P (out) && UNARY_P (in))
7806 {
7807 rtx insn;
7808 rtx op1;
7809 rtx out_moded;
7810 rtx set;
7811
7812 op1 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 0));
7813 if (op1 != XEXP (in, 0))
7814 in = gen_rtx_fmt_e (GET_CODE (in), GET_MODE (in), op1);
7815
7816 /* First, try a plain SET. */
7817 set = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
7818 if (set)
7819 return set;
7820
7821 /* If that failed, move the inner operand to the reload
7822 register, and try the same unop with the inner expression
7823 replaced with the reload register. */
7824
7825 if (GET_MODE (op1) != GET_MODE (out))
7826 out_moded = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (op1), REGNO (out));
7827 else
7828 out_moded = out;
7829
7830 gen_reload (out_moded, op1, opnum, type);
7831
7832 insn
7833 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out,
7834 gen_rtx_fmt_e (GET_CODE (in), GET_MODE (in),
7835 out_moded));
7836 insn = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (insn);
7837 if (insn)
7838 {
7839 REG_NOTES (insn)
7840 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV, in, REG_NOTES (insn));
7841 return insn;
7842 }
7843
7844 fatal_insn ("Failure trying to reload:", set);
7845 }
7846 /* If IN is a simple operand, use gen_move_insn. */
7847 else if (OBJECT_P (in) || GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG)
7848 {
7849 tem = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (out, in));
7850 /* IN may contain a LABEL_REF, if so add a REG_LABEL note. */
7851 mark_jump_label (in, tem, 0);
7852 }
7853
7854 #ifdef HAVE_reload_load_address
7855 else if (HAVE_reload_load_address)
7856 emit_insn (gen_reload_load_address (out, in));
7857 #endif
7858
7859 /* Otherwise, just write (set OUT IN) and hope for the best. */
7860 else
7861 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
7862
7863 /* Return the first insn emitted.
7864 We can not just return get_last_insn, because there may have
7865 been multiple instructions emitted. Also note that gen_move_insn may
7866 emit more than one insn itself, so we can not assume that there is one
7867 insn emitted per emit_insn_before call. */
7868
7869 return last ? NEXT_INSN (last) : get_insns ();
7870 }
7871
7872 /* Delete a previously made output-reload whose result we now believe
7873 is not needed. First we double-check.
7874
7875 INSN is the insn now being processed.
7876 LAST_RELOAD_REG is the hard register number for which we want to delete
7877 the last output reload.
7878 J is the reload-number that originally used REG. The caller has made
7879 certain that reload J doesn't use REG any longer for input. */
7880
7881 static void
delete_output_reload(rtx insn,int j,int last_reload_reg)7882 delete_output_reload (rtx insn, int j, int last_reload_reg)
7883 {
7884 rtx output_reload_insn = spill_reg_store[last_reload_reg];
7885 rtx reg = spill_reg_stored_to[last_reload_reg];
7886 int k;
7887 int n_occurrences;
7888 int n_inherited = 0;
7889 rtx i1;
7890 rtx substed;
7891
7892 /* It is possible that this reload has been only used to set another reload
7893 we eliminated earlier and thus deleted this instruction too. */
7894 if (INSN_DELETED_P (output_reload_insn))
7895 return;
7896
7897 /* Get the raw pseudo-register referred to. */
7898
7899 while (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
7900 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
7901 substed = reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (reg)];
7902
7903 /* This is unsafe if the operand occurs more often in the current
7904 insn than it is inherited. */
7905 for (k = n_reloads - 1; k >= 0; k--)
7906 {
7907 rtx reg2 = rld[k].in;
7908 if (! reg2)
7909 continue;
7910 if (MEM_P (reg2) || reload_override_in[k])
7911 reg2 = rld[k].in_reg;
7912 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
7913 if (rld[k].out && ! rld[k].out_reg)
7914 reg2 = XEXP (rld[k].in_reg, 0);
7915 #endif
7916 while (GET_CODE (reg2) == SUBREG)
7917 reg2 = SUBREG_REG (reg2);
7918 if (rtx_equal_p (reg2, reg))
7919 {
7920 if (reload_inherited[k] || reload_override_in[k] || k == j)
7921 {
7922 n_inherited++;
7923 reg2 = rld[k].out_reg;
7924 if (! reg2)
7925 continue;
7926 while (GET_CODE (reg2) == SUBREG)
7927 reg2 = XEXP (reg2, 0);
7928 if (rtx_equal_p (reg2, reg))
7929 n_inherited++;
7930 }
7931 else
7932 return;
7933 }
7934 }
7935 n_occurrences = count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), reg, 0);
7936 if (substed)
7937 n_occurrences += count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn),
7938 eliminate_regs (substed, 0,
7939 NULL_RTX), 0);
7940 for (i1 = reg_equiv_alt_mem_list [REGNO (reg)]; i1; i1 = XEXP (i1, 1))
7941 {
7942 gcc_assert (!rtx_equal_p (XEXP (i1, 0), substed));
7943 n_occurrences += count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), XEXP (i1, 0), 0);
7944 }
7945 if (n_occurrences > n_inherited)
7946 return;
7947
7948 /* If the pseudo-reg we are reloading is no longer referenced
7949 anywhere between the store into it and here,
7950 and we're within the same basic block, then the value can only
7951 pass through the reload reg and end up here.
7952 Otherwise, give up--return. */
7953 for (i1 = NEXT_INSN (output_reload_insn);
7954 i1 != insn; i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1))
7955 {
7956 if (NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK_P (i1))
7957 return;
7958 if ((NONJUMP_INSN_P (i1) || CALL_P (i1))
7959 && reg_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (i1)))
7960 {
7961 /* If this is USE in front of INSN, we only have to check that
7962 there are no more references than accounted for by inheritance. */
7963 while (NONJUMP_INSN_P (i1) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i1)) == USE)
7964 {
7965 n_occurrences += rtx_equal_p (reg, XEXP (PATTERN (i1), 0)) != 0;
7966 i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1);
7967 }
7968 if (n_occurrences <= n_inherited && i1 == insn)
7969 break;
7970 return;
7971 }
7972 }
7973
7974 /* We will be deleting the insn. Remove the spill reg information. */
7975 for (k = hard_regno_nregs[last_reload_reg][GET_MODE (reg)]; k-- > 0; )
7976 {
7977 spill_reg_store[last_reload_reg + k] = 0;
7978 spill_reg_stored_to[last_reload_reg + k] = 0;
7979 }
7980
7981 /* The caller has already checked that REG dies or is set in INSN.
7982 It has also checked that we are optimizing, and thus some
7983 inaccuracies in the debugging information are acceptable.
7984 So we could just delete output_reload_insn. But in some cases
7985 we can improve the debugging information without sacrificing
7986 optimization - maybe even improving the code: See if the pseudo
7987 reg has been completely replaced with reload regs. If so, delete
7988 the store insn and forget we had a stack slot for the pseudo. */
7989 if (rld[j].out != rld[j].in
7990 && REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (reg)) == 1
7991 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (reg)) == 1
7992 && REG_BASIC_BLOCK (REGNO (reg)) >= 0
7993 && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (reg)))
7994 {
7995 rtx i2;
7996
7997 /* We know that it was used only between here and the beginning of
7998 the current basic block. (We also know that the last use before
7999 INSN was the output reload we are thinking of deleting, but never
8000 mind that.) Search that range; see if any ref remains. */
8001 for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
8002 {
8003 rtx set = single_set (i2);
8004
8005 /* Uses which just store in the pseudo don't count,
8006 since if they are the only uses, they are dead. */
8007 if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
8008 continue;
8009 if (LABEL_P (i2)
8010 || JUMP_P (i2))
8011 break;
8012 if ((NONJUMP_INSN_P (i2) || CALL_P (i2))
8013 && reg_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (i2)))
8014 {
8015 /* Some other ref remains; just delete the output reload we
8016 know to be dead. */
8017 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn, insn);
8018 delete_insn (output_reload_insn);
8019 return;
8020 }
8021 }
8022
8023 /* Delete the now-dead stores into this pseudo. Note that this
8024 loop also takes care of deleting output_reload_insn. */
8025 for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
8026 {
8027 rtx set = single_set (i2);
8028
8029 if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
8030 {
8031 delete_address_reloads (i2, insn);
8032 delete_insn (i2);
8033 }
8034 if (LABEL_P (i2)
8035 || JUMP_P (i2))
8036 break;
8037 }
8038
8039 /* For the debugging info, say the pseudo lives in this reload reg. */
8040 reg_renumber[REGNO (reg)] = REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx);
8041 alter_reg (REGNO (reg), -1);
8042 }
8043 else
8044 {
8045 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn, insn);
8046 delete_insn (output_reload_insn);
8047 }
8048 }
8049
8050 /* We are going to delete DEAD_INSN. Recursively delete loads of
8051 reload registers used in DEAD_INSN that are not used till CURRENT_INSN.
8052 CURRENT_INSN is being reloaded, so we have to check its reloads too. */
8053 static void
delete_address_reloads(rtx dead_insn,rtx current_insn)8054 delete_address_reloads (rtx dead_insn, rtx current_insn)
8055 {
8056 rtx set = single_set (dead_insn);
8057 rtx set2, dst, prev, next;
8058 if (set)
8059 {
8060 rtx dst = SET_DEST (set);
8061 if (MEM_P (dst))
8062 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XEXP (dst, 0), current_insn);
8063 }
8064 /* If we deleted the store from a reloaded post_{in,de}c expression,
8065 we can delete the matching adds. */
8066 prev = PREV_INSN (dead_insn);
8067 next = NEXT_INSN (dead_insn);
8068 if (! prev || ! next)
8069 return;
8070 set = single_set (next);
8071 set2 = single_set (prev);
8072 if (! set || ! set2
8073 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) != PLUS || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set2)) != PLUS
8074 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)) != CONST_INT
8075 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1)) != CONST_INT)
8076 return;
8077 dst = SET_DEST (set);
8078 if (! rtx_equal_p (dst, SET_DEST (set2))
8079 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0))
8080 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 0))
8081 || (INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))
8082 != -INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1))))
8083 return;
8084 delete_related_insns (prev);
8085 delete_related_insns (next);
8086 }
8087
8088 /* Subfunction of delete_address_reloads: process registers found in X. */
8089 static void
delete_address_reloads_1(rtx dead_insn,rtx x,rtx current_insn)8090 delete_address_reloads_1 (rtx dead_insn, rtx x, rtx current_insn)
8091 {
8092 rtx prev, set, dst, i2;
8093 int i, j;
8094 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
8095
8096 if (code != REG)
8097 {
8098 const char *fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
8099 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8100 {
8101 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
8102 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XEXP (x, i), current_insn);
8103 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
8104 {
8105 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8106 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XVECEXP (x, i, j),
8107 current_insn);
8108 }
8109 }
8110 return;
8111 }
8112
8113 if (spill_reg_order[REGNO (x)] < 0)
8114 return;
8115
8116 /* Scan backwards for the insn that sets x. This might be a way back due
8117 to inheritance. */
8118 for (prev = PREV_INSN (dead_insn); prev; prev = PREV_INSN (prev))
8119 {
8120 code = GET_CODE (prev);
8121 if (code == CODE_LABEL || code == JUMP_INSN)
8122 return;
8123 if (!INSN_P (prev))
8124 continue;
8125 if (reg_set_p (x, PATTERN (prev)))
8126 break;
8127 if (reg_referenced_p (x, PATTERN (prev)))
8128 return;
8129 }
8130 if (! prev || INSN_UID (prev) < reload_first_uid)
8131 return;
8132 /* Check that PREV only sets the reload register. */
8133 set = single_set (prev);
8134 if (! set)
8135 return;
8136 dst = SET_DEST (set);
8137 if (!REG_P (dst)
8138 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, x))
8139 return;
8140 if (! reg_set_p (dst, PATTERN (dead_insn)))
8141 {
8142 /* Check if DST was used in a later insn -
8143 it might have been inherited. */
8144 for (i2 = NEXT_INSN (dead_insn); i2; i2 = NEXT_INSN (i2))
8145 {
8146 if (LABEL_P (i2))
8147 break;
8148 if (! INSN_P (i2))
8149 continue;
8150 if (reg_referenced_p (dst, PATTERN (i2)))
8151 {
8152 /* If there is a reference to the register in the current insn,
8153 it might be loaded in a non-inherited reload. If no other
8154 reload uses it, that means the register is set before
8155 referenced. */
8156 if (i2 == current_insn)
8157 {
8158 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8159 if ((rld[j].reg_rtx == dst && reload_inherited[j])
8160 || reload_override_in[j] == dst)
8161 return;
8162 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8163 if (rld[j].in && rld[j].reg_rtx == dst)
8164 break;
8165 if (j >= 0)
8166 break;
8167 }
8168 return;
8169 }
8170 if (JUMP_P (i2))
8171 break;
8172 /* If DST is still live at CURRENT_INSN, check if it is used for
8173 any reload. Note that even if CURRENT_INSN sets DST, we still
8174 have to check the reloads. */
8175 if (i2 == current_insn)
8176 {
8177 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8178 if ((rld[j].reg_rtx == dst && reload_inherited[j])
8179 || reload_override_in[j] == dst)
8180 return;
8181 /* ??? We can't finish the loop here, because dst might be
8182 allocated to a pseudo in this block if no reload in this
8183 block needs any of the classes containing DST - see
8184 spill_hard_reg. There is no easy way to tell this, so we
8185 have to scan till the end of the basic block. */
8186 }
8187 if (reg_set_p (dst, PATTERN (i2)))
8188 break;
8189 }
8190 }
8191 delete_address_reloads_1 (prev, SET_SRC (set), current_insn);
8192 reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (dst)] = -1;
8193 delete_insn (prev);
8194 }
8195
8196 /* Output reload-insns to reload VALUE into RELOADREG.
8197 VALUE is an autoincrement or autodecrement RTX whose operand
8198 is a register or memory location;
8199 so reloading involves incrementing that location.
8200 IN is either identical to VALUE, or some cheaper place to reload from.
8201
8202 INC_AMOUNT is the number to increment or decrement by (always positive).
8203 This cannot be deduced from VALUE.
8204
8205 Return the instruction that stores into RELOADREG. */
8206
8207 static rtx
inc_for_reload(rtx reloadreg,rtx in,rtx value,int inc_amount)8208 inc_for_reload (rtx reloadreg, rtx in, rtx value, int inc_amount)
8209 {
8210 /* REG or MEM to be copied and incremented. */
8211 rtx incloc = find_replacement (&XEXP (value, 0));
8212 /* Nonzero if increment after copying. */
8213 int post = (GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_INC
8214 || GET_CODE (value) == POST_MODIFY);
8215 rtx last;
8216 rtx inc;
8217 rtx add_insn;
8218 int code;
8219 rtx store;
8220 rtx real_in = in == value ? incloc : in;
8221
8222 /* No hard register is equivalent to this register after
8223 inc/dec operation. If REG_LAST_RELOAD_REG were nonzero,
8224 we could inc/dec that register as well (maybe even using it for
8225 the source), but I'm not sure it's worth worrying about. */
8226 if (REG_P (incloc))
8227 reg_last_reload_reg[REGNO (incloc)] = 0;
8228
8229 if (GET_CODE (value) == PRE_MODIFY || GET_CODE (value) == POST_MODIFY)
8230 {
8231 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == PLUS);
8232 inc = find_replacement (&XEXP (XEXP (value, 1), 1));
8233 }
8234 else
8235 {
8236 if (GET_CODE (value) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC)
8237 inc_amount = -inc_amount;
8238
8239 inc = GEN_INT (inc_amount);
8240 }
8241
8242 /* If this is post-increment, first copy the location to the reload reg. */
8243 if (post && real_in != reloadreg)
8244 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, real_in));
8245
8246 if (in == value)
8247 {
8248 /* See if we can directly increment INCLOC. Use a method similar to
8249 that in gen_reload. */
8250
8251 last = get_last_insn ();
8252 add_insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, incloc,
8253 gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (incloc),
8254 incloc, inc)));
8255
8256 code = recog_memoized (add_insn);
8257 if (code >= 0)
8258 {
8259 extract_insn (add_insn);
8260 if (constrain_operands (1))
8261 {
8262 /* If this is a pre-increment and we have incremented the value
8263 where it lives, copy the incremented value to RELOADREG to
8264 be used as an address. */
8265
8266 if (! post)
8267 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, incloc));
8268
8269 return add_insn;
8270 }
8271 }
8272 delete_insns_since (last);
8273 }
8274
8275 /* If couldn't do the increment directly, must increment in RELOADREG.
8276 The way we do this depends on whether this is pre- or post-increment.
8277 For pre-increment, copy INCLOC to the reload register, increment it
8278 there, then save back. */
8279
8280 if (! post)
8281 {
8282 if (in != reloadreg)
8283 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, real_in));
8284 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
8285 store = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
8286 }
8287 else
8288 {
8289 /* Postincrement.
8290 Because this might be a jump insn or a compare, and because RELOADREG
8291 may not be available after the insn in an input reload, we must do
8292 the incrementation before the insn being reloaded for.
8293
8294 We have already copied IN to RELOADREG. Increment the copy in
8295 RELOADREG, save that back, then decrement RELOADREG so it has
8296 the original value. */
8297
8298 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
8299 store = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
8300 if (GET_CODE (inc) == CONST_INT)
8301 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, GEN_INT (-INTVAL(inc))));
8302 else
8303 emit_insn (gen_sub2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
8304 }
8305
8306 return store;
8307 }
8308
8309 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
8310 static void
add_auto_inc_notes(rtx insn,rtx x)8311 add_auto_inc_notes (rtx insn, rtx x)
8312 {
8313 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
8314 const char *fmt;
8315 int i, j;
8316
8317 if (code == MEM && auto_inc_p (XEXP (x, 0)))
8318 {
8319 REG_NOTES (insn)
8320 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_INC, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), REG_NOTES (insn));
8321 return;
8322 }
8323
8324 /* Scan all the operand sub-expressions. */
8325 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
8326 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8327 {
8328 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
8329 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, XEXP (x, i));
8330 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
8331 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8332 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, XVECEXP (x, i, j));
8333 }
8334 }
8335 #endif
8336
8337 /* Copy EH notes from an insn to its reloads. */
8338 static void
copy_eh_notes(rtx insn,rtx x)8339 copy_eh_notes (rtx insn, rtx x)
8340 {
8341 rtx eh_note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL_RTX);
8342 if (eh_note)
8343 {
8344 for (; x != 0; x = NEXT_INSN (x))
8345 {
8346 if (may_trap_p (PATTERN (x)))
8347 REG_NOTES (x)
8348 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EH_REGION, XEXP (eh_note, 0),
8349 REG_NOTES (x));
8350 }
8351 }
8352 }
8353
8354 /* This is used by reload pass, that does emit some instructions after
8355 abnormal calls moving basic block end, but in fact it wants to emit
8356 them on the edge. Looks for abnormal call edges, find backward the
8357 proper call and fix the damage.
8358
8359 Similar handle instructions throwing exceptions internally. */
8360 void
fixup_abnormal_edges(void)8361 fixup_abnormal_edges (void)
8362 {
8363 bool inserted = false;
8364 basic_block bb;
8365
8366 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
8367 {
8368 edge e;
8369 edge_iterator ei;
8370
8371 /* Look for cases we are interested in - calls or instructions causing
8372 exceptions. */
8373 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->succs)
8374 {
8375 if (e->flags & EDGE_ABNORMAL_CALL)
8376 break;
8377 if ((e->flags & (EDGE_ABNORMAL | EDGE_EH))
8378 == (EDGE_ABNORMAL | EDGE_EH))
8379 break;
8380 }
8381 if (e && !CALL_P (BB_END (bb))
8382 && !can_throw_internal (BB_END (bb)))
8383 {
8384 rtx insn;
8385
8386 /* Get past the new insns generated. Allow notes, as the insns
8387 may be already deleted. */
8388 insn = BB_END (bb);
8389 while ((NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || NOTE_P (insn))
8390 && !can_throw_internal (insn)
8391 && insn != BB_HEAD (bb))
8392 insn = PREV_INSN (insn);
8393
8394 if (CALL_P (insn) || can_throw_internal (insn))
8395 {
8396 rtx stop, next;
8397
8398 stop = NEXT_INSN (BB_END (bb));
8399 BB_END (bb) = insn;
8400 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
8401
8402 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->succs)
8403 if (e->flags & EDGE_FALLTHRU)
8404 break;
8405
8406 while (insn && insn != stop)
8407 {
8408 next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
8409 if (INSN_P (insn))
8410 {
8411 delete_insn (insn);
8412
8413 /* Sometimes there's still the return value USE.
8414 If it's placed after a trapping call (i.e. that
8415 call is the last insn anyway), we have no fallthru
8416 edge. Simply delete this use and don't try to insert
8417 on the non-existent edge. */
8418 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE)
8419 {
8420 /* We're not deleting it, we're moving it. */
8421 INSN_DELETED_P (insn) = 0;
8422 PREV_INSN (insn) = NULL_RTX;
8423 NEXT_INSN (insn) = NULL_RTX;
8424
8425 insert_insn_on_edge (insn, e);
8426 inserted = true;
8427 }
8428 }
8429 insn = next;
8430 }
8431 }
8432
8433 /* It may be that we don't find any such trapping insn. In this
8434 case we discovered quite late that the insn that had been
8435 marked as can_throw_internal in fact couldn't trap at all.
8436 So we should in fact delete the EH edges out of the block. */
8437 else
8438 purge_dead_edges (bb);
8439 }
8440 }
8441
8442 /* We've possibly turned single trapping insn into multiple ones. */
8443 if (flag_non_call_exceptions)
8444 {
8445 sbitmap blocks;
8446 blocks = sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block);
8447 sbitmap_ones (blocks);
8448 find_many_sub_basic_blocks (blocks);
8449 }
8450
8451 if (inserted)
8452 commit_edge_insertions ();
8453
8454 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
8455 /* Verify that we didn't turn one trapping insn into many, and that
8456 we found and corrected all of the problems wrt fixups on the
8457 fallthru edge. */
8458 verify_flow_info ();
8459 #endif
8460 }
8461